Académique Documents
Professionnel Documents
Culture Documents
CODE: 00ZMXM310/S1E
DIGITAL MULTIFUNCTIONAL
SYSTEM
MX-M260/M310
MODEL MX-M260N/M310N
CONTENTS
Parts marked with are important for maintaining the safety of the set. Be sure to replace these parts with
specified ones for maintaining the safety and performance of the set.
[RSPF]
Staple cartridge
[MX-SCX1]
Finisher
[MX-FN13]
Machine stand Machine stand Paper feed unit Paper feed unit
(Large) (Small) (500 Sheets) (500x2 Sheets)
[MX-DS11] [MX-DS12] [MX-DE10] [MX-DE11]
[MX-M260/M310]
Data security kit
(Commercial version) FAX expantion kit Expantion memory board FAX memory (8MB) Printer expantion kit
[AR-FR17U]
(For 26cpm)
[AR-FR18U] [AR-SM5](256MB)
(For 31cpm) [AR-FX7] [AR-SM6](512MB) [AR-MM9] [MX-PB12]
[MX-USX1/
MX-USX5/
MX-US10/
MX-US50/
[MX-AMX1] MX-USA0] [MX-NSX1] [AR-PF1] [AR-PF2] [MX-PK10]
Measuring conditions: When paper of A4 or 8.5 x 11 is fed from the CPU --- TMPR4937
machine tray, with the polygon rotating. (64bit, 300MHz)
Interface Ethernet No 10Base-T/100Base-TX
(6) Engine resolution
USB 2.0 Full Speed 1slot
Writing resolution 600 x 600dpi
Device
Smoothing (Print) 1200dpi (equivalent) x 600dpi
Memory No 64MB (Standard)
Gradation Writing: Binary + 256MB x 1
(7) Printable range Memory --- 1 slot (144 pin DIMM
expansion slot compatible)
Max. print size AB series: 416 x 293mm
(600dpi: 9826dot x 6920dot) (2) Memory
Inch series: 428 x 275mm
Local Memory Standard 32MB
(600dpi: 10110dot x 6496dot)
Expansion 512MB x 2
Void area image loss Lead edge 4.0mm or less
Rear edge 4.0mm or less Max. 1056MB
Total of lead/rear edges 4mm1mm
C. Operation panel
Type Dot matrix LCD, touch panel
Size Monochrome H-VGA 8.1
Display dot number 640 x 240 (H-VGA)
LCD drive display area 192 x 72mm
LCD backlight Fluorescent lamp backlight system
LCD contrast adjustment Yes
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SPECIFICATIONS 2 - 1
D. Scanner section (3) Automatic document feeder
(1) Resolution/Gradation Type RSPF
(Automatic duplex document feeder unit)
Reading Copy mode
resolution Scan speed When in single copy When in duplex copy
Platen 400 x 600dpi
(dpi) Copy 31-sheet model: 31-sheet model:
RSPF 400 x 600dpi 27 sheets/min 17 side/min
Transmission FAX transmission mode (400 x 600dpi) (400 x 600dpi)
resolusion Select mode Normal Fine Super Ultra 26-sheet model: 26-sheet model:
(dpi) text text fine fine 26 sheets/min 14 side/min
text text (400 x 600dpi) (400 x 600dpi)
Input resolution: 203.2 203.2 203.2 406.4 Fax 40 sheets/min 17 sheets/min
OC x x x x (Normal text, A4R) (Normal text, A4R)
293.4 293.4 391.2 586.7 Scanner 31 sheets/min 16 sheets/min
Input resolution: 203.2 203.2 203.2 406.4 (300 x 300dpi) (300 x 300dpi)
RSPF x x x x Document set Face-up reference
293.4 293.4 391.2 586.7 direction
Transmission 203.2 203.2 203.2 406.4 Document standard Center reference
resolution x x x x position
97.8 195.6 391 391 Document transport Sheet through system
Half tone No Yes Yes Yes system
Scanner mode Document size AB series: A3 - A5,0
Select mode 200 x 300 x 400 x 600 x Inch series: 11 x 17 - 5.5 x 8.5
200 300 400 600 Document weight Single face: 35 - 128g/m2, 9 - 34 lbs,
Input resolution: 600 x 600 x 600 x 600 x Duplex: 52 - 105g/m2, 13.9 - 28 lbs
OC 600 600 600 600 Max. loading 100 sheets (90g/m2)
Input resolution: 600 x 600 x 600 x 600 x capacity of Paper thickness of 13mm or less can be set.
RSPF 367 367 367 367 documents
Transmission 200 x 300 x 400 x 600 x Transport disable OHP, perforated documents, photo,
resolution 200 300 400 600 document catalogue, second original sheet, tracing
Reading 256 gradations paper, carbon paper, heat-sensitive paper,
gradation wrinkled paper, folded or broken paper,
pasted or cut-away paper, documents of
Exposure Electrodeless xenon lamp many perforated holes (2-hole, 3-hole
lamp documents can be used), document printed
Output Binary by an ink ribbon
gradation
Detection Yes
(2) Document table Detection size Inch Automatic setting
Type Document table fixed type (Flat bed) series 11 x 17, 8.5 x 14, 8.5 x 11,
8.5 x 11R, 5.5 x 8.5, A3, A4
Scanning area 297 x 431.8mm
Manual setting
Original standard Left bottom reference 11 x 17, 8.5 x 14, 8.5 x 13 (216 x
position 330), 8.5 x 11, 8.5 x 11R,
Detection Yes 5.5 x 8.5, A3, A4, A4R
Detection size Inch Automatic setting AB Automatic setting
series 11 x 17, 8.5 x 14, 8.5 x 11, series 11 x 17, 8.5 x 11, A3, B4, A4,
8.5 x 11R, 5.5 x 8.5 A4R, B5, B5R, A5
Manual setting Manual setting
11 x 17, 8.5 x 14, 8.5 x 13 (216 x 11 x 17, 8.5 x 14, 8.5 x 13 (216 x
330), 8.5 x 11, 8.5 x 11R, 330), 8.5 x 11, 8.5 x 11R, A3, B4,
5.5 x 8.5, A3, A4, A4R A4, A4R, A5
AB Automatic setting Multi copy S-S, S-D, D-D, D-S
series A3, B4, A4, A4R, A5 Mixed paper feed Enable (Same width only)
Manual setting
11 x 17, 8.5 x 14, 8.5 x 13 (216 x
330), 8.5 x 11, 8.5 x 11R, A3, B4,
A4, A4R, A5
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SPECIFICATIONS 2 - 2
E. Paper feed section
Type Paper feed tray + Multi manual paper feed (Expanded up to 4 trays by installing options.)
Paper feed method Paper is fed from the above by the front loading system.
Details of paper feed section Tray1 Tray2 Manual paper feed tray
Paper capacity Standard paper 500 sheets 100 sheets
(80g/m2)
Paper size A3, B4, A4, A4R, B5, B5R, A3, B4, A4, A4R, B5R, A3, B4, A4, A4R, B5, B5R, A5R, A5,
A5, 11 x 17, 8.5 x 14, 11 x 17, 8.5 x 14 (216 x 356), B6R, 11 x 17, 8.5 x 14 (216 x 356),
8.5 x 13, 8.5 x 11, 8.5x11R, 8.5 x 13 (216 x 330), 8.5 x 13 (216 x 330), 8.5 x 11,
5.5 x 8.5, 8K, 16K, 16KR 8.5 x 11, 8.5 x 11R, 8K, 16KR 8.5 x 11R, 7.25 x 10.5R, 5.5 x 8.5,
8K, 16K, 16KR, A6R, Envelope*1
Paper size detection No Yes
Allowable paper type and weight for paper 56 - 105g/m2/15 - 28lbs Bond Multi paper feed:
feed Standard paper (56 - 128g/m2)
Special paper, heavy paper (max.
200g/m2)
Single paper feed:
Standard paper, special paper,
second original, heavy paper (max.
200g/m2), 56- 200g/m2 (14 - 54lbs)
Paper type Standard paper (56 - 80g/m2) Standard paper: 100 sheets
Normal paper (60 - 105g/m2) (56 - 80g/m2)
Letterhead Recycled paper/coarse paper:
Color paper 100 sheets
Postcard/Double postcard
(without fold): 30 sheets
Heavy paper (max. 200g/m2):
30 sheets
OHP/Label sheet/gift wrapping
paper: 40 sheets
Label sheet: 40 sheets
Envelope (AB series: 10 sheets,
Inch series: 5 sheets)
Paper size setting when Inch series 8.5 x 11 ---
shipping AB series A4 ---
Paper remaining detection No (paper presence only)
1: Supported envelope kinds: Commercial10 (4 - 1/8 x 9 - 1/2), International DL (110mm x 220mm), International C5 (162mm x 229mm)
(3) Duplex
System Switchback system
Paper size A3, B4, A4, A4R, B5, B5R, A5, 11 x 17,
8.5 x 14, 8.5 x 13, 8.5 x 11, 8.5 x 11R
Type and weight of 56 - 105g/m2/15 - 21.3 lbs Bond
paper which can be Duplex print from manual paper feed can be
passed made. (Except for heavy paper, OHP sheet,
and other special paper)
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SPECIFICATIONS 2 - 3
(4) Copy functions (3) PDL emulation/Font
Automatic paper selection Emulation Built-in fonts Option font
Automatic magnification ratio selection PCL5e European outline font Barcode font
Vertical/horizontal independent magnification ratio compatible/ = 80 typefaces = 28 typefaces
PCL6 Line printer font (BMP)
Paper type selection
compatible = 1 typeface
Auto tray switching
ESC/P European BMP font
Rotation copy (VP-1100) = 2 typefaces
Electronic sort compatible (Roman, San-serif)
Job reservation (only during warm-up) Postscript3 European outline font
Tray installation priority compatible = 136 typefaces
Program call-out/registration (10 items) (4) Print channel
Preheat function Support print PSERVER/RPRINT for netware environment
Auto power shut off function channel LPR
User management (100 items) IPP
Mixed documents feed (MIX only) PAP : EtherTalk (AppleTalk)
Binding margin (Left/Right/Upper) FTP
Edge erase/Center erase (Center/Edge/Center + Edge) NetBEUI
1 set 2 copy Raw Port (Port 9100)
Cover paper/Insert paper/Tab insert paper (Cover/Back cover only) USB 2.0
Multi shot (2 in 1/4 in 1) (Centering available) HTTP (Web Submit Print)
Card shot (Centering available) POP3 (E-Mail To Print)
Half binding (Centering available) HTTPS
Duplex copy direction switching (5) Environment setting
Large volume document mode Setting item Outline
Black/white reverse (except for UK) Default setting Basic setting for using the printer, such as
Stream feeding mode (ON/OFF switch by the system setting) the number of copies, the printing direction.
SPDL Setting of SPDL symbol and fonts
H. Printer function
PS Setting of print Enable/Disable in case of PS
(1) Platform error
IBM PC/AT
I. Image send function
Macintosh
(1) Mode
(2) Support OS
Scanner Scan to e-mail
Custom Custom Custom
OS SPLC PPD Scan to Desktop
PCL6 PCL5e PS
Scan to FTP
Windows 2000
Yes Fax Fax
XP Yes
XP x64 No (2) Support system
Server Mode Scanner Fax
Yes
2003 Corresponding SMTP ---
No
Server server/protocol FTP (TCP/IP)
No
2003 x64 Yes Yes
(3) Support image
Vista Yes
Yes Mode Scanner Fax
Vista x64
File format TIFF ---
Server Yes
PDF
2008
Compression system Non-compression MH
Server
2008 x64 G3 = MH MR
Mac 9.0 - 9.2.2 G4 = MMR MMR
No
No JBIG
X 10.2.8
X 10.3.9
No No
X 10.4.11
X 10.5 -
10.5.6
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SPECIFICATIONS 2 - 4
(4) Number of registration items (7) Send function
Item Scanner Fax Mode Scanner Fax
One-touch/ Group 200 items 500 items Memory send
(max. 100 items for (max. 200 items for Onhook
one group) one group)
Quick online send
Max. 500 items in
total with 200 items Direct transmission
of groups Auto reductions end
Program No 8 items (Auto magnification A33B4,
ratio send) A33A4,
Memory box No Bulletin Board/
B43A4
Confidential/Relay
broadcast, each 10 Rotation send
items Recall Error
Sender registration --- 20 items mode Busy
Sender list 200 items No No. of times and time
Item name Direct input only No are set by the system
(Detailed setting of (Default or direct setting.
transmission) input) Long document send
File name 30 items No Max. 1000mm
(Detailed setting of (except for ultra fine
transmission) mode)
Meta data set list 10 items No No. of registration Max. 200 items
items of senders
Receive rejection No 50 items
number (8) Receive function
Polling allow number No 10 items Mode Scanner Fax
ID number No 10 items Automatic reception
System number No 1 item Manual reception
Interface ID code No 10 items Memory reception
Confidential box No 10 items Fixed size reduction
number reception
(5) Image process Rotation reception
Mode Scanner Fax (9) Report/List function
Document scan color Black/White only Mode Scanner Fax
Half tone reproductions Equivalent of 256 steps Communication record table
Density adjustment Auto + 5 steps Communication reservation table
(6) Address specification Bulletin board check table
Mode Scanner Fax ID sender table *
Address Specified by one- Specified by one- Confidential reception check table
specification touch, group, or direct touch, group, or direct One-touch dial list
address input. address input. Group list
Input from the soft Program list
keyboard
Telephone number list
Selection from
LDAP server Interface group list
Number of One- Max. (number of keys): 500 items (including F code memory box list
touch address key 200 items the group dial) User management record table (Fax)
registration Rejection number list
Number of Max. 100 items Number of addresses Confidential ID table
addresses to be registered to 1 group
Web setting list
registered in a (1 key) :
group (1 key) max. 200 items The sender table is printed as the ID sender table.
Program 8 items
Direct address Input from the soft Input with 10 key,
input keyboard # key, key
Chain dial
(Supported by the
pause key)
Resend The latest single
destination is called
out.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SPECIFICATIONS 2 - 5
(10) Other functions Functions PC-FAX send
Mode Scanner Fax (When FAX is installed)
Time specification Max. number of FAX number digits 40
digits (excluding the sub address and
Poling receive
pass code)
Cover paper adding
Resolution 200 x 100dpi/200 x 200dpi/200 x 400dpi/
function
400 x 400dpi
Page division
Send A3/B4/A4/A5/B5/11 x 17/8.5 x 14/
Send message document size 8.5 x 11/5.5 x 8.5/8.5 x 13/8k/16k
Program Compression MH/MMR/MR
Sender selection system
Thin film scan Broadcast
Communication send (Max. 200 items)
result table F-code send Sub
address Max.
(11) Record size 20 digit
Mode Scanner Fax Pass code
Max. record width --- 293mm Max.
Record size --- A3 - A5/ 20 digit
11 x 17 - 5.5 x 8.5 Telephone
book
(12) Sound setting registration,
Mode Item System setting send function
Onhook sound Sound volume setting Covering letter
Call-out sound Sound volume setting attachment (Disable when broadcasting)
volume function
Line monitor sound Sound volume setting Covering letter
making
Communication end Sound volume
function
sound Sound pattern
Sender print
Communication end (Editing senders is disabled.)
sounding time
Preview
(13) PC-FAX function
J. Environmental conditions
Operation OS Windows 2000
Windows XP/XP x64 (Humidity)
Windows Vista/Vista x64 85%
Windows Server 2003 */
Server 2003 x64* 60%
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SPECIFICATIONS 2 - 6
[3] CONSUMABLE PARTS
1. Supply system table
A. SEC/ SECL/ LAG
No. Item Content Life Model name Remarks
1 Toner cartridge Toner cartridge (With IC chip) 1 25K MX-312NT Life setting by A4 (8.5"11") 6% document
(black) (Toner; Net 700g)
2 Developer (black) Developer 1 26cpm: 75K MX-312NV
(Developer; Net 300g) 31cpm: 100K
3 Drum Drum 1 26cpm: 75K MX-312NR
31cpm: 100K
B. Brazil
No. Item Content Life Model name Remarks
1 Toner cartridge Toner cartridge (With IC chip) 1 25K MX-312BT Life setting by A4 (8.5"11") 6% document
(black) (Toner; Net 700g)
2 Developer (black) Developer 1 26cpm: 75K MX-312NV
(Developer; Net 300g) 31cpm: 100K
3 Drum Drum 1 26cpm: 75K MX-312NR
31cpm: 100K
D. Asia affiliates
No. Item Content Life Model name Remarks
1 Toner cartridge Toner cartridge (With IC chip) 1 25K MX-312AT Life setting by A4 (8.5"11") 6% document
(black) (Toner; Net 700g)
2 Developer (black) Developer 1 26cpm: 75K MX-312AV
(Developer; Net 300g) 31cpm: 100K
3 Drum Drum 1 26cpm: 75K MX-312AR
31cpm: 100K
E. Hong Kong
No. Item Content Life Model name Remarks
1 Toner cartridge Toner cartridge (With IC chip) 1 25K MX-312AT Life setting by A4 (8.5"11") 6% document
(black) (Toner; Net 700g)
2 Developer (black) Developer 1 26cpm: 75K MX-312AV
(Developer; Net 300g) 31cpm: 100K
3 Drum Drum 1 26cpm: 75K MX-312AR
31cpm: 100K
The other maintenance parts than the above are supplied as service parts.
B. SEGA/ SUK/ SCA/ SCNZ/ SEA/ SEES/ SEZ/ SEIS/ SEB/ SEN/ SEF/ SMEF/ Russia/ Special country
(MX-M260/M310)
Model
No. Item Content Life Remarks
name
1 Upper heat roller kit Upper heat roller 1 150K AR-310UH
Fuser gear 1
Upper heat roller bearing 2
Upper cleaning pad 1
Fusing separation pawl (upper) 4
Thermistor cleaning pad 2
2 Lower heat roller kit Lower heat roller 1 300K MX-311LH
Fusing separation pawl (lower) 4
Fuser bearing (lower) 2
3 150K PM kit Drum separation pawl unit 2 150K MX-311KA
Transfer roller unit 1
DV blade 1
DV side sheet F 1
DV side sheet R 1
Toner filter unit 1
4 MC unit MC unit 10 26cpm: 75K (10) MX-311MC
31cpm: 100K (10)
5 Cleaner blade Cleaner blade 10 26cpm: 75K (10) MX-311CB
31cpm: 100K (10)
6 Drum frame unit Drum frame unit 1 26cpm: 225K MX-311DU The life of the toner reception seat attached to
31cpm: 300K the drum frame is 300K, and it can be used up
to 3 times. (Supplied as a drum frame unit.)
7 Transfer roller unit Transfer roller unit 1 150K MX-311TX
8 Staple cartridge Staple cartridge 3 5000 staples 3 MX-SCX1
The other maintenance parts than the above are supplied as service parts.
Number of rotations
Developer/drum counter
(Rotations)
Developer/drum 26cpm model 31cpm model 550K
75K 100K
Label position
85%
60%
20%
10 C 30 C 35 C
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
(Temperature)
The lot number is of 8 digits. Each digit indicates the content as follows.
The number is printed on the right under side of the back surface of the Standard environmental Temperature 20 - 25C
developer bag. conditions Humidity 65 5%RH
1 Alphabet Usage environmental Temperature 10 - 35C
Indicates the production factory. conditions Humidity 20 - 85%RH
2 Number Atmospheric 590 - 1013 hPa
Indicates the production year. pressure (height: 0 - 2000m)
3, 4 Number Storage period Toner/Developer: 24 months from the
Indicates the production month. manufactured month (Production lot)
5, 6 Number under unsealed state
Indicates the production day. Drum: 36 months from the manufactured
7 Hyphen month under unsealed state
8 Number
Indicates the production lot.
1 2 3 6
16
4
8 5
12
11
9 17
13 19
10 14 20
18
21
15
6
2
4
5
COPY
ON LINE
PRINT
DATA
SCAN DATA
LINE
FAX
DATA
JOB STATUS SYSTEM SETTINGS
LOGOUT
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
5
4
No. Name
1 Document set tray
2 Document guide
3 Document feed section cover
4 Document transport section cover
5 Document exit section
B. Internal structure
11
10
9
8
7
3
5
6
14 4
12 13
1
2
19
18
17
26 16 15 14
1
No. Name Code Function and operation
1 Mirror home position MHPS Mirror (scanner) home
sensor position detection
2 Document cover OCSW Document cover open/close
sensor detection 4
3 Document size DSIN3 Document size detection
sensor (Inch series: PD3, 4)
(AB series: PD4, 5)
4 2nd paper exit sensor POD2 2nd paper exit detection
(Option)
5 2nd paper exit full TOPF 2nd paper exit section full
detection sensor detection
(Option)
6 1st paper exit sensor POD1 1st paper exit detection
7 Shifter home position SFTHP Shifter home position sensor
sensor (Except North detection
America)
8 Paper exit sensor PPD2 Paper exit detection
3 2
(DUP side)
9 Thermistor Fusing temperature No. Name Code Function and operation
detection 1 Right cabinet door DSWR0 Right cabinet door open/
10 1st tray (paper tray) CD1 1st tray (paper tray) empty switch (Option) close detection
detection detection 2 Door switch DSWR1 Front door and side door
11 Manual feed paper PPD1L Sensor of paper entry from open/close detection
entry sensor the manual paper feed tray, 3 2nd right door switch DSWR2 Side door open/close
the 2nd/multi-tray desk, or detection
the DUP 4 Main switch PSSW Main power switch
12 Manual paper feed MPLS2 Manual feed tray position
tray empty sensor 2 detection
13 Manual paper feed MPLS1 Manual feed tray position
tray empty sensor 1 detection
14 Manual feed length MPLD1 Manual feed paper length
detection sensor 1 detection
15 Manual feed length MPLD2 Manual feed paper length
detection sensor 2 detection
16 Manual feed paper MPED Manual feed paper empty
empty sensor detection
17 2nd tray paper pass PFD2 2nd tray paper pass
sensor
2
1
4
6
2
3
4
5
9
8
7 6 8 7
No. Name Code Function and operation No. Name Code Function and operation
1 Paper exit gate OGS Paper exit gate switcher 1 Mirror motor MIRM Optical mirror base drive
switching solenoid 2 Shifter motor SFTM Shifter drive
(Option) (Except North
2 PS clutch RRC Main unit paper feed America)
3 Paper feed clutch CPFS1 Paper feed roller drive 4 Duplex motor DPXM Duplex paper switching
4 Manual paper feed MPFS Manual paper feed and exit motor
solenoid solenoid 5 DUP-2 motor Reverse pass for paper
5 Paper feed transfer TRC2 Paper feed transfer clutch transport
clutch 6 Main motor MM Main drive
6 2nd tray paper feed CPFS2 7 Tray lift-up motor LUM1 Tray paper lift-up
clutch 8 Tray lift-up motor LUM2 Tray paper lift-up
7 2nd tray paper feed CPFC2 Solenoid for the paper feed 9 Toner motor TM Toner supply
solenoid from the tray
8 Paper feed solenoid CPFC1 Solenoid for the paper feed
from the tray
9 Separation pawl PSPS Separation pawl operation
solenoid solenoid
6
7
2 1
3 5
6
1
4
No. Name Function and operation No. Name Code Function and operation
1 Copy lamp Image radiation lamp 1 Cooling fan VFM Cools the inside of the unit.
2 Heater lamp Fusing heat lamp 2 Exhaust fan motor DCFM Cools the inside of the unit.
3 Intake fan motor DCFM2
4 Fusing paper exit fan VFM2 Cools the inside of the unit.
(31 sheet model)
5 Fusing paper exit fan VFM2 Cools the inside of the unit.
6 Ozon filter
7 Ozon filter
2
3
3
11 4
4 5
10 6
7
8
5
6
9
10
11
12
8
14 13
9
No. Name Function and operation
7 1 Paper exit roller Paper exit roller
2 Transport roller Paper transport roller
No. Name Function and operation 3 Upper heat roller Fuses toner on paper.
1 Inverter PWB Copy lamp control (with the Teflon roller)
2 CCD PWB For image scanning (read) 4 Lower heat roller Fuses toner on paper.
3 Option connector PWB (with the silicone rubber roller)
4 IMC PWB Image process 5 DUP transport follower Duplex paper transport
5 MCU PWB Main unit control roller
6 Mother board Connection with FAX PWB and 6 DUP transport roller Duplex paper transport
PCL PWB 7 Transport roller Transfer images on the drum onto
7 Tray interface PWB 2nd tray control paper.
8 DC power supply PWB DC voltage control 8 Resist roller Synchronize the paper lead edge
9 High voltage PWB High voltage control with the image lead edge.
10 KEY PWB 9 Manual paper feed roller Picks up papers in manual paper
11 OPU PWB Operation panel control feed port.
10 Manual feed transport Transports paper from the manual
roller paper feed port.
11 1st tray pick-up roller Picks up paper from the tray.
12 1st tray paper feed roller Transports the picked up paper to
RESIST section.
13 2nd tray pick-up roller Picks up paper from the tray.
14 2nd tray paper feed roller Transports the picked up paper to
RESIST section.
2. Details of adjustment
A. Process section 2) Loosen the developing doctor fixing screw A.
3) Insert a thickness gauge of 1.5mm to the positions of three screws
(1) Developing doctor gap adjustment
on the developing docter as shown.
1) Remove the doctor cover.
R
A
C
A
F
A
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N ADJUSTMENTS 5 - 1
(2) MG roller main pole position adjustment (4) Grid bias voltage adjustment (SIM 8-2)
1) Put the developing unit on a flat surface. 1) Execute SIM 8-2.
2) Tie a needle or pin on a string.
3) Hold the string and bring the needle close to the MG roller horizon- SIMULATION 8-2
tally. (Do not use paper clip, which is too heavy to make a correct
adjustment.) (Put the developing unit horizontally for this adjust-
ment.)
4) Do not bring the needle into contact with the MG roller, but bring it
to a position 2 or 3mm apart from the MG roller. Mark the point on
the MG roller which is on the extension line from the needle tip.
5) Measure the distance from the marking position to the top of the
doctor plate of the developing unit to insure that it is 9.1mm.
If the distance is not within the specified range, loosen the fixing 2) Touch the exposure mode to be changed.
screw A of the main pole adjustment plate, and move the adjust- The current set value is displayed.
ment plate in the arrow direction to adjust. 3) Enter the set value with the 10-key.
4) Press the [START] key.
Output is made with the entered value for 30sec, and the display
returns to the original state.
<Adjustment specification>
Setting
Item Content Default
A range
1 AE (145) AE (145mm/s) 590
9.1mm
Character
2 TEXT (145) 590
(145mm/s)
TEXT/PHOTO Character/Photo
3 590
(145) (145mm/s)
4 PHOTO (145) Photo (145mm/s) 590
(3) Developing bias voltage adjustment (SIM 8-1)
TONER SAVE Toner save
1) Execute SIM 8-1. 5 540
(145) (145mm/s) 350-
6 AE (122) AE (122mm/s) 750 590
SIMULATION 8-1
SIMULATION 8-1
DV BIAS COPY SETTING. INPUT VALUE 200-550, AND PRESS Character
START. 7 TEXT (122) 590
(122mm/s)
1: AE 426 426
2: TEXT 450 1/1 TEXT/PHOTO Character/Photo
8 590
3: TEXT/PHOTO 450 (122) (122mm/s)
4: PHOTO 450
5: SUPER/PHOTO 400
9 PHOTO (122) Photo (122mm/s) 590
6: TONER SAVE 376 TONER SAVE Toner save
10 540
(122) (122mm/s)
2) Touch the exposure mode to be changed. Min. unit: 10V increment
The current set value is displayed.
3) Enter the set value with the 10-key.
B. Mechanism section
4) Press the [START] key. (1) Print start position adjustment
Output is made with the entered value, and the display returns to 1) Execute SIM 50-5.
the original state.
SIMULATION 50-5
<Adjustment specification> LEAD EDGE ADJUSTMENT(PRINT). INPUT VALUE 0-99, AND PRESS
Setting START.
Item Content Default 1: TRAY1 53 53
range
2: OPTION 53 1/1
1 AE (145) AE (145mm/s) 450 3: MANUAL 53
Character 4: DUPLEX 53
2 TEXT (145) 450
(145mm/s)
TEXT/PHOTO Character/Photo
3 450
(145) (145mm/s)
4 PHOTO (145) Photo (145mm/s) 450 2) Touch the item to be adjusted.
TONER SAVE Toner save The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
5 400
(145) (145mm/s) 200- 3) Press the [P] key.
6 AE (122) AE (122mm/s) 650 450 The display is shifted to the copy menu.
Character 4) Select the paper feed tray, the print density, and the duplex mode.
7 TEXT (122) 450
(122mm/s) Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key.
TEXT/PHOTO Character/Photo 5) Press the [START] key.
8 450
(122) (122mm/s) Copying is started.
9 PHOTO (122) Photo (122mm/s) 450
TONER SAVE Toner save
10 400
(122) (122mm/s)
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N ADJUSTMENTS 5 - 2
Item Content Setting range Default (2) RSPF image lead edge position adjustment
1 TRAY1 1st tray 0-99 1) Set a scale on the OC table as shown below.
2 OPTION Option tray
53
3 MANUAL Manual feed 1-99
4 DUPLEX Back print
6) Measure the distance H between the paper lead edge and the
image print start position. Set the image print start position set
value again.
1 step of the set value corresponds to about 0.127mm shift.
Calculate the set value from the formula below.
99 H/0.127 (mm) = Image print start position set value
<H: Print start position measurement value (mm)> Note: Since the printed copy is used as a test chart, put the scale in
paralleled with the edge lines.
0mm 2) Make a copy, then use the copy output as an original to make an
RSPF copy again.
0mm 3) Check the copy output. If necessary, perform the following adjust-
5
ment procedures.
4) Execute SIM 50-6.
10
5) Set the RSPF lead edge position set value so that the same image
is obtained as that obtained in the previous OC image lead edge
position adjustment.
<Adjustment specification>
Adjustment Setting
Fit the print edge with the paper edge, and perform the lead SIM Set value Spec value
mode range
edge adjustment.
RSPF 50-6 1 step: Lead edge void:
Example:99 5/0.127 = 99 39.4 = about 59
image lead 0.127mm 1 4mm
Note: FIf the set value is not obtained from the above formula, per- 1 99
edge shift Image loss: 3mm or less
form the fine adjustment. position
7) Execute SIM 50-1-2 to adjust the main tray lead edge void.
(3) Rear edge void adjustment
1 step of the set value corresponds to about 0.127mm shift.
1) Set a scale as shown in the figure below.
Calculate the set value from the formula below.
A4 (8.5" x 11")
B/0.127 (mm) = Lead edge void adjustment value
<B: Lead edge void (mm)>
2.5mm
5
2.5mm
10
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N ADJUSTMENTS 5 - 3
(4) Paper off center adjustment (5) Left edge void area adjustment
1) Set a test chart (UKOG-0089CSZZ) on the document table. Note: Before performing this adjustment, be sure to check that the
2) Select a paper feed port and make a copy. paper off center adjustment (SIM 50-10) is completed.
3) Execute SIM 50-10. 1) Execute SIM 50-1.
SIMULATION 50-1
SIMULATION 50-10
LEAD EDGE ADJUSTMENT. INPUT VALUE 1-99, AND PRESS START.
PRINT OFF-CENTER ADJUSTMENT. INPUT VALUE 1-99, AND
1: RRC-A 43 2: DEN-A 18 43
PRESS START.
3: DEN-A -MANUAL 18 4: DEN-A -OPTION 18
1: BYPASS 50 50
5: DEN-A -DUPLEX 18 6: DEN-B 3 1/1
2: TRAY1 50 1/1
7: DEN-B-DUP 50 8: SIDE VOID 18
3: TRAY2 50
9: SIDE VOID-DUP 18 10: LOSS(OC) 3
4: TRAY3 50
5: TRAY4 50
6: DUPLEX 50 OK
OK
2) Note down the adjustment value of SIM 50-5 (Items 1, 2, 3, 4), and
4) Touch the item to be adjusted. change the value to 99.
The item and the currently set value are highlighted. 3) Set SIM 50-1 (Items 2, 3, 4, 5) to 1. (By setting to 1, there is no
5) Press the [START] key. void.)
The display is shifted to the copy menu. 4) Place a chart with a clear lead edge (or a ruler) on the OC docu-
6) Select the paper feed tray and the print density. ment table.
Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key. 5) Use SIM 50-1 (Item 1) to execute test print. Check the print out and
7) Press the [START] key. adjust so that the lead edge image is printed. (1 99: About
Copying is started. 0.127mm/Step)
Item Content Setting range Default 6) Reset the adjustment values of SIM 50-5 (Items 1, 2, 3, 4) to the
original values, and execute test print. Check the print out and
1 BYPASS Manual paper feed
adjust so that the lead edge image is printed on the lead edge of
2 TRAY1 1st tray
paper. (1 99: About 0.127mm/Step).
3 TRAY2 2nd tray
1-99 50 7) Adjust SIM 50-1 (Items 2, 3, 4, 5) so that the lead edge void on the
4 TRAY3 3rd tray
print out is the specified value. (1 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
5 TRAY4 4th tray
8) Similar to procedure 7, adjust SIM 50-1 (Item 6, 7) so that the rear
6 DUPLEX Back print
edge void is the specified value. (1 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
<Adjustment specification> 9) Similar to procedure 7, adjust SIM 50-1 (Item 8, 9) so that the left
Adjustment Setting edge void is the specified value. (1 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
SIM Set value Spec value
mode range 10) Make an enlargement copy (400%), and check that there is no
Paper off 50-10 Add 1: 0.127mm Single: shade of the cabinet printed at the lead edge.
center -2 shift to R side. Center 11) If there is a shade printed at the lead edge in procedure 9, adjust
Reduce 1: 2.0mm SIM 50-1 (Item 10). (1 5: About 0.677mm)
1 99
Second 50-10 0.127mm shift to L Duplex: * If there is no problem, set to 3.
print surface -6 side. Center
Setting
off-center 2.5mm Item Content Default
range
1 RRC-A Original scan start position 1-99 43
adjustment
Lead edge position
adjustment value (OC)
2 DEN-A Lead edge cancel 1-99 18
adjustment (Main tray)
3 DEN-A-MANUAL Lead edge cancel 1-99 18
adjustment
(Manual feed tray)
4 DEN-A-OPTION Lead edge cancel 1-99 18
adjustment (Option tray)
5 DEN-A-DUPLEX Lead edge cancel 1-99 18
adjustment
(back of the machine)
6 DEN-B Rear edge void adjustment 1-99 30
7 DEN-B-DUP Rear edge void adjustment 1-99 50
(Duplex)
8 SIDE VOID Left edge void adjustment 1-99 18
(First print surface)
9 SIDE VOID-DUP Left edge void adjustment 1-99 18
(Duplex)
10 LOSS(OC) Image loss amount 1-5 3
adjustment (Lead edge
image loss set value) (OC)
<Adjustment specification>
Adjustment Spec Setting
SIM Set value
mode value range
Left edge void 50-1 1 step: 0.127mm 0.5 4mm 1 99
-8 shift
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N ADJUSTMENTS 5 - 4
(6) Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion 5) Without moving the scanner drive pulley shaft, manually turn the
balance adjustment scanner drive pulley until the positioning plate is brought into con-
tact with No. 2/3 mirror base unit, then fix the scanner drive pulley.
1) Remove the OC glass, the right cabinet and the upper right side
cover.
1
3 1
1
1 2
4
6) Put No. 2/3 mirror base unit on the positioning plate again, push
4
the projections on the front frame side and the rear frame side of
the copy lamp unit to the corner frame, and tighten the wire fixing
2) Loosen the copy lamp unit wire fixing screw. screw.
3) Manually turn the mirror base drive pulley and bring No. 2/3 mirror
base unit into contact with the positioning plate.
At that time, if the front frame side and the rear frame side of No. 2/
3 mirror base unit are brought into contact with the positioning
plate at the same time, the mirror base unit parallelism is proper.
If one of them is in contact with the positioning plate, perform the
adjustment of 4).
La Lb
Paper exit
direction
Original Copy
4) Loosen the set screw of the scanner drive pulley which is not in
contact with No. 2/3 mirror base unit positioning plate.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N ADJUSTMENTS 5 - 5
1) Set A3 (11" x 17") white paper on the original table as shown <Adjustment specification>
below. La = Lb
6) Execute the main scanning direction (FR) distortion balance
adjustment previously described in 2) again.
(8) Main scanning direction (FR direction) distortion
balance adjustment (Rail height adjustment)
When there is no skew copy in the mirror base scanning direction and
there is no horizontal error (right angle to the scanning direction), the
adjustment can be made by adjusting the No. 2/3 mirror base unit rail
height.
Place a little clearance from
the rear side original guide. Before performing this adjustment, be sure to perform the horizontal
image distortion adjustment in the laser scanner section.
This adjustment must be performed in the following cases:
When the mirror base wire is replaced.
When the copy lamp unit and no. 2/3 mirror unit are replaced.
When the mirror unit rail is replaced and moved.
When a following copy is made.
Glass holding plate A3 (11" x 17") white paper Original Copy A Copy B
Fit the paper edge and
the glass holding plate edge.
1) Make an original for the adjustment.
2) Open the original cover and make a normal (100%) copy.
Make test sheet by drawing parallel lines at 10mm from the both
3) Measure the width of the black background at the lead edge and at
ends of A3 (11" x 17") white paper as shown below. (These lines
the rear edge.
must be correctly parallel to each other.)
10mm 10mm
Lb Ld
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N ADJUSTMENTS 5 - 6
4) Move the mirror base B rail position up and down (in the arrow <Adjustment specification>
direction) to adjust. Note: A judgment must be made with 200mm width, and must not be
made with 100mm width.
Adjustment Setting
Spec value SIM Set value
mode range
Main scanning At normal: 48- Add 1: 0.1% 1 99
direction 1.0% 1-1 increase
magnification Reduce 1: 0.1%
ratio decrease
(10) Sub scanning direction (scanning direction)
magnification ratio adjustment
(SIM 48-1-2, SIM 48-1-3)
a. OC mode in copying
Note: Execute the procedure after completion of SIM 48-1-1.
1) Put a scale on the original table as shown below, and make a nor-
mal (100%) copy.
When La > Lb
Shift the mirror base B rail upward by the half of the difference of
LaLb.
When La < Lb
Shift the mirror base B rail downward by the half of the difference
of LbLa.
Example: When La = 12mm and Lb = 9mm, shift the mirror base
B rail upward by 1.5mm.
2) Compare the scale image and the actual scale.
When Lc >Ld If necessary, perform the following adjustment procedures.
Shift the mirror base B rail downward by the half of the difference
3) Execute SIM 48-1-2.
of LcLd.
4) Enter the set value and press the start key.
When Lc < Ld
The set value is stored and a copy is made.
When Lc < Ld, move the mirror base B on the paper feed side
upward. <Adjustment specification>
When moving the mirror base rail, hold the mirror base rail with Adjustment Setting
Spec value SIM Set value
your hand. mode range
<Adjustment specification> Sub scanning At normal: 48-1- Add 1: 1 99
direction 1.0% 2 0.05% increase
La = Lb, Lc = Ld
magnification Reduce 1:
5) After completion of adjustment, manually turn the mirror base drive ratio (OC mode) 0.05% decrease
pulley, scan the mirror base A and mirror base B fully, and check
that the mirror bases are not in contact with each other. b. RSPF mode in copying
If the mirror base rail is moved extremely, the mirror base may be in Note: Before performing this adjustment, be sure to check that the
contact with the frame or the original glass. Be careful to avoid this. CCD unit is properly installed and that OC mode adjustment in
copying has been completed.
(9) Main scanning direction (FR direction) magnification 1) Put a scale on the original table as shown below, and make a nor-
ratio adjustment (SIM 48-1) mal (100%) copy to make a test chart.
Note: Before performing this adjustment, be sure to check that the
CCD unit is properly installed.
1) Put a scale on the original table as shown below.
Note: Since the printed copy is used as a test chart, put the scale in
parallel with the front side edge of the glass.
2) Set the test chart on the RSPF and make a normal (100%) copy.
2) Execute SIM 48-1.
3) Compare the scale image and the actual image.
3) After warm-up, shading is performed and the current set value of If necessary, perform the following adjustment procedures.
the main scanning direction magnification ratio is displayed on the
4) Execute SIM 48-1-3.
display section in 2 digits.
5) After warm-up, shading is performed.
4) Manual correction mode (SIM48-1-1)
The current front surface sub scanning direction magnification ratio
Enter the set value and press the start key. correction value is displayed in two digits on the display section.
The correction value is stored and a copy is made.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N ADJUSTMENTS 5 - 7
6) Enter the set value and press the start key. <Adjustment specification>
The set value is stored and a copy is made. OC (SPF) open/close position A: 125 225mm
7) Execute SIM 48-1-4. 3) If the distance is outside the specified range, adjust the open/close
The current back surface sub scanning direction magnification ratio sensor attachment plate position as shown below.
is displayed in two digits on the display section.
Distance < 125mm: Shift toward A.
8) Enter the set value and press the start key.
Distance > 225mm: Shift toward B.
The set value is stored and a copy is made.
<Adjustment specification>
Spec Setting
Adjustment mode SIM Set value
value range
Sub scanning At normal: 48-1-3 Add 1: 1 99
direction 1.0% 48-1-4 0.05% increase
magnification ratio Reduce 1: A
(RSPF mode) 0.05% decrease
(11) Off center adjustment (RSPF mode)
Note: Before performing this adjustment, be sure to check that the
paper off center is properly adjusted.
1) Place the center position adjustment test chart (sheet with a B
straight line in the scan direction at the center) on the RSPF.
2) Make a normal copy from the manual paper feed tray, and check
the printed copy with the test chart. (13) Original sensor adjustment (SIM 41-2, 41-4)
If any adjustment is required, perform the following procedure. 1) Set A3 (11" x 17") paper on the OC table.
3) Execute SIM 50-12. (Keep the SPF (OC cover) open.)
4) After warm-up, shading is performed and the current set value of 2) Execute SIM 41-2.
the off center adjustment is displayed on the display section in 2 3) Keep A=125mm, and execute SIM 41-4. (Do not put paper on the
digits. table.)
5) Enter the set value and press the start key. 4) Check the reaction with SIM 41-1.
The set value is stored and a copy is made.
(14) RSPF white correction pixel position adjustment
<Adjustment specification> (required in an RSPF model when replacing the lens
Adjustment Setting unit) (SIM63-7)
Spec value SIM Set value
mode range 1) Fully open the RSPF.
Original off Single: Center 50-12 Add 1: 0.1mm 1 99 2) Execute SIM 63-7.
center mode 3.0mm shift to R side
3) When the operation panel displays "COMPLETE," the adjustment
(RSPF Duplex: Center Reduce 1: 0.1mm
is completed.
mode) 3.5mm shift to L side
4) If the operation panel displays "ERROR," perform the following
(12) OC (RSPF) open/close detection position adjustment measures.
1) Execute SIM 41-3. When the display is 0:
2) Gradually close the OC (RSPF) from the full open position, and Check that the SPF is open.
measure distance A when the display on the operation panel Check that the lamp is ON. (If the lamp is OFF, check the MCU con-
changes. (See the figure below.) nector.)
Check that the CCD harness is properly inserted into the MCU con-
nector.
When the display is 281 or above:
1) Remove the table glass.
2) Remove the dark box.
3) Slide the lens unit toward the front side and attach it, then exe-
Distance A = Table glass top - OC (RSPF) handle rib cute SIM.
When the display is 143 or below:
1) Remove the table glass.
2) Remove the dark box.
3) Slide the lens unit toward the rear side and attach it, then execute
SIM.
F R
When the lens unit is moved, execute the OC main scanning magni-
fication ratio auto adjustment, SIM 48-1-1.
This adjustment is basically O.K. with SIM 63-7.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N ADJUSTMENTS 5 - 8
(15) RSPF scan position auto adjustment C. Image density (exposure) adjustment
[Function] (1) Copy mode (SIM46-2)
Used to adjust the RSPF scan position automatically. 1) Set a test chart (UKOG-0162FCZZ) on the OC table as shown
[Operation] below.
1) With the RSPF or the OC cover open, place a white paper back- Rear
ground on the OC glass. (In the RSPF standard model, the RSPF
glass surface is included.)
2) Enter SIM53-08, and press [START] button.
Outline of SIM: The optical unit is shifted to recognize the bound-
ary between the OC glass and the RSPF glass cover.
With the same position as the reference, the RSPF scan position is
automatically adjusted.
<Note>
After completion of the RSPF scan position auto adjustment, the
RSPF lead edge adjustment must be executed. (Both surfaces)
There must be no other sheet than the black chart on the glass sur-
face. Front
Especially when in RSPF scan, the center area is scanned in the 2) Place three or more sheets of A3 (11" x 17") paper on the test
main scan direction. Be careful to prevent external light from enter- chart.
ing the scan area.
3) Execute SIM 46-2.
3) Check that the lead edge is not shifted. (Both surfaces)
4) After warm-up, shading is performed and the current set value of
(If the original lead edge adjustment has been made properly, even
the density (exposure) level is displayed on the display section in 2
when the scan position is shifted, it is followed automatically.)
digits.
For mode selection, use the [10-key].
For the RSPF standard-provision
Place only the white
machine, check that the white 5) Change the set value with the [10-key] to adjust the copy image
paper on the OC glass.
paper covers the SPF glass. density.
6) Make a copy and check that the specification below is satisfied.
Note: Place originals in the rear reference, and the test chart in the
front reference when adjusting the exposure.
<Adjustment specification>
Exposure Sharp Gray Setting
Density mode Set value
level Chart output range
Placing the white paper
AUTO "3" is copied. If too bright,
The white chart must cover TEXT 3.0 "3" is copied. increase the
this area. quantity displayed
TEXT/PHOTO 3.0 "3" is copied.
on the copy
PHOTO 3.0 "2" is copied. quantity display.
AE (TONER If too dark, 0 99
"3" is copied.
SAVE) decrease the
TEXT (TONER quantity displayed
3.0 "3" is copied.
SAVE) on the copy
TEXT PHOTO quantity display.
3.0 "3" is copied.
(TONER SAVE)
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N ADJUSTMENTS 5 - 9
[6] SIMULATION
1. General B. Code-type simulation
A. Outline and purpose (1) Operating procedures and operations
The simulation has the following functions to grasp the machine oper- * Entering the simulation mode
ating status, identify the trouble position and causes in an earlier stage, 1) #/P key (program) ON Asterisk (*) key ON CLEAR key ON
and make various setups and adjustments speedily for improving the Asterisk (*) key ON Ready for input of a main code of simulation
serviceability of the machine. 2) Entering a main code with the 10-key START key ON
1) Various adjustments 3) Entering a sub code with the 10-key START key ON
2) Setup of specifications and functions 4) Select an item with the scroll key and the item key.
3) Canceling troubles 5) The machine enters the mode corresponding to the selected item.
4) Operation check Press START key to start the simulation operation.
5) Various counters check, setup, and clear To cancel the current simulation mode or to change the main code
6) Machine operating status (operation history) data check, clear and the sub code, press the SYSTEM SETTINGS key.
7) Transfer of various data (adjustments, setup, operations, counters) * Canceling the simulation mode to return to the normal mode
The operating procedures and the displays differ depending on the 1) Press CLEAR ALL key.
form of the operation panel of the machine. (2) How to change the simulation adjustment value set by
the touch panel in the adjustment value entry process
a. Target SIM list
3-7, 8-1, 8-2, 8-3, 8-10, 8-11, 8-12, 9-5, 43-1, 44-34, 46-2, 46-9, 46-10,
46-11, 46-18, 46-20, 46-30, 46-31, 48-1, 48-2, 50-1, 50-5, 50-6, 50-10,
50-12, 51-1, 51-2, 51-9, 53-7
b. Touch panel operating procedure
In the adjustment value setup menu, the selected item is highlighted.
Change is made to the highlighted simulation adjustment value.
If all the list of the adjustment items is not shown on one page, touch
[] and [] button to shift the page.
To change an adjustment value, touch the select the item to change
the adjustment value. (The selected item is highlighted.) Enter the
adjustment value and perform one of the following procedures, and
the display of the adjustment value of the selected item is renewed
as well as the adjustment value.
1) Touch [OK] button.
2) Touch another selected item to change the selection state.
3) If all the list of the adjustment items cover two or more pages,
touch [] and [] button to shift the page.
4) Press [START] key.
* For simulations which allow confirmation print, copying is started
after changing the adjustment value.
(46-2, 46-9, 46-10, 46-11, 46-18, 48-1, 48-2, 50-1, 50-5, 50-6, 50-10,
50-12, 51-2, the bold-faced items in the above list.)
* If the entry value is outside the adjustable range, an error buzzer
sounds and the adjustment value is not renewed. Page shift is not
made, either.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 1
START (Normal mode)
L1
3
Press the START key. Do you want NO
to perform another
simulation ?
2
YES
NO
Is there a sub code ? Press the SYSTEM
SETTINGS key
YES
NO 4
Is there a item
selection?
YES
YES
Operation check ?
YES
Operating conditions
check ? If "Operation condition check"
Press the START key. refer to "Sensor display", this
NO
process is not necessary.
Do you NO
want to change the
content ?
YES 1
L1
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 2
2. Simulation code list Code
Function
Main Sub
Code
Function Used to cancel excluding the self-diag U2/PF
Main Sub 14 0
troubles.
Used to check the operation of the scanner unit 16 0 Used to cancel the self-diag U2 trouble.
1
and its control circuit.
1 17 0 Used to cancel the self diag PF trouble.
Used to check the operation of sensor and detector
2 21 1 Used to set the maintenance cycle.
in the scanning (read) section and the related circuit.
1 Used to check the counter value of each section.
Used to check the operation of the RSPF unit and
1 Used to check the total numbers of misfeed and
the related circuit.
troubles. (When the number of misfeed is
Used to check the operation of sensors and detectors
2 2 2 considerably great, it is judged as necessary for
in the RSPF unit and the related circuit.
repair. The misfeed rate is obtained by dividing this
Used to check the operation of the loads in the count value with the total counter value.)
3
RSPF unit and the control circuits.
Used to check the misfeed positions and the
Used to check the operation of sensor and detector number of misfeed at each position.
2 3
in the finisher and the related circuit.
(When the number of misfeed is considerably
Used to check the operation of the load in the great, it can be judged as necessary for repair.)
3
finisher and the control circuit.
4 Used to check the total trouble (self diag) history.
10 Used to make each adjustment of the finisher. Used to check the ROM version of each unit
3
Used to check the shifter operation. 5
(section).
Reciprocating operations are continuously Used to print each key operator setting, the
11 performed or the home position is checked.
6 account information, and the machine adjustment
(The shifter is shifted to the home position or 22 values.
moved in one way by the specified steps.)
7 Used to display of the administrator password.
Used to check the operation of sensor and detector
2 8 Used to display the original, staple counter.
in the option tray and the related circuit.
4 Used to check the number of use of each paper
Used to check the operation of the load in the 9
3 feed section. (the number of prints)
option tray and the control circuit.
10 Used to check the system configuration.
Used to check the operation of the display (LED),
1 Used to display the FAX send/receive counter
LCD in the operation panel, and control circuit. 11
(FAX reception and print counter).
Used to check the operation of the heater lamp and
5 2 Used to check the misfeed positions and the
the control circuit.
number of misfeed at each position.
Used to check the operation of the copy lamp and 12
3 (When the number of misfeed is considerably
the control circuit.
great, it can be judged as necessary for repair.)
Used to check the operation of the loads (clutches
13 Used to display the CRUM type.
1 and solenoids) in the paper transport system and
Used to display the scanner counter in the network
6 the control circuit. 19
scanner mode.
Used to check the operation of each fan motor and
2 Used to clear the misfeed counter, the misfeed
its control circuit.
history, the trouble counter, and the trouble history.
1 Used to set the aging operation conditions. 1
(The counters are cleared after completion of
7 6 Used to set the cycle of intermittent aging. maintenance.)
8 Used to set the display of the warm-up time.
Used to clear the number of use (the number of
Used to check and adjust the operation of the 2
prints) of each paper feed section.
1 developing bias voltage in each copy mode and the
Used to clear the number usage data of the stapler,
control circuit. 3
RSPF, and scanning.
Used to check and adjust the operation of the main
4 Used to reset the maintenance counter.
2 charger grid voltage in each copy mode and the
Used to reset the developer counter.
control circuit.
24 5 (The developer counter of the DV unit which is
Used to check and adjust the operation of the installed is reset.)
10 developing bias voltage in each printer mode and
6 Used to clear the copy counter.
the control circuit.
8 Used to clear the OPC drum (membrane decrease)
Used to check and adjust the operation of the main
7 correction counter. (This simulation is executed
11 charger grid voltage in each printer mode and the
when the OPC drum is replaced.)
control circuit.
Used to clear the printer counter and other
Used to check and adjust the operation of the 9
counters.
13 developing bias voltage in FAX mode and the
10 FAX counter data clear
control circuit.
Used to clear the scanner counter in the network
Used to check and adjust the operation of the main 15
scanner mode.
14 charger grid voltage in FAX mode and the control
circuit. Used to check the operation of the main drive
(excluding the scanner section) and to check the
Used to check and adjust the operation of the load
1 1 operation of the toner concentration sensor.
(motor) in the duplex section and the control circuit.
25 (The toner concentration sensor output can be
4 Duplex motor RPM setting
9 monitored.)
Used to adjust the timing of switching from normal
Used to make the initial setting of toner
5 rotation to reverse rotation or from reverse rotation 2
concentration when replacing developer.
to normal rotation of the duplex motor.
Used to check the operation of the toner motor and
10 0
its control circuit.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 3
Code Code
Function Function
Main Sub Main Sub
Used to set whether the job separator is installed Used to check the sensor of the machine manual
1
1 or not. (Since this cannot be detected by hardware feed tray.
detection, it is set in this simulation.) Used to adjust the manual paper feed tray paper
40 2
Used to set whether the automatic detection of width detector detection level.
2
paper size is made or not. The AD conversion value of manual feed width
3
Used to set the specifications of the auditor. detection is displayed.
3 Setting must be made depending on the use Used to check the document size detection photo
condition of the auditor. 1
sensor.
Used to set the count mode of the total counter and Used to adjust the detection level of the document
5 2
the maintenance counter. size photo sensor.
Used to set the specifications depending on the 41 Used to check the light reception level and the
6
destination. 3 detection level of the original size detection photo
10 Network scanner trial mode setting sensor.
12 Used to input the Software Key for E-MAIL RIC. Used to adjust the detection level of OC 20
4
Used to input the Software Key for the PS degrees.
14
extension kit. 1 Used to set the fusing temperature.
18 Used to set enable/disable of toner save operation. 43 Used to set the paper feed cycle timing when
10
Used to set the specification (language display) for printing postcards.
22
the destination. Used to make various setups in each mode of
1
Used to set ON/OFF of the heater lamp slow-up process control.
30
control conforming to the CE mark control. 2 Drum life correction setting
Used to set whether the same continuous troubles 3 Used to set the DV count correction.
26 are displayed as one trouble or the series of Used to display the process control correction
35 9
troubles with SIM 22-4 when the same troubles information.
occur continuously. Used to display the environment (temperature,
14
Used to set whether the machine is stopped or not humidity) correction information.
36
when the maintenance counter life is expired. 44 Used to set the toner density control correction
16
Used to set ON/OFF of the black and white value.
50
reversion function. Used to display the toner density control reference
17
56 Gamma life correction setting value.
57 Used to set the model code. Used to set the transfer current value in each
34
Used to set enable/disable of the FAX mode key mode.
60 when FAX is not installed. (When FAX is installed, Used to set the time from the start of the main
the FAX mode is enabled regardless of this setup.) 40 motor rotation (Ready) to the start of toner supply
69 Toner near end setting in previous rotation after turning on the power.
In the power save time setting, the pre-heat (pre- Used to set the exposure level in each exposure
2
heat mode setting) and the auto power shut off mode.
time can be set to the short time setup (pre-heat: 1 Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination
71
min, auto power shut off: 4 min) and the long time 9 value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode
setup (pre-heat: 15min, auto power shut off: (Text).
60min). Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination
The letterhead support is set. 10 value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode
When Letterhead paper setting is selected, the (Text/Photo).
72
set value of SIM 26-46 (Image output direction Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination
setting) is set to Setting Enable accordingly. 11 value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode
Used to set PC/MODEM communication trouble (Photo).
1
(U7-00) detection Yes/No. FAX exposure level adjustment
Senders registration number/HOST server TEL 12
(1 mode automatic adjustment)
2
number. FAX exposure level adjustment
4 Function setting 13
(Normal mode individual adjustment)
27 5 Used to set the tag number 46 FAX exposure level adjustment
14
7 FSS function setting (Fine text mode individual adjustment)
9 FSS function adjustment FAX exposure level adjustment
15
10 Trouble precognition history clear (Super Fine mode individual adjustment)
14 FSS connection test setting FAX exposure level adjustment
16
15 Displays status of FSS connection (Ultra Fine mode individual adjustment)
Used to display the sensor status attached to the 18 Used to adjust inclination for each exposure mode.
1
machine. Used to set the control method of the exposure
19
Used to display the status of the sensors attached mode.
30
to the standard tray and the manual feed tray. (Use Used to set the exposure correction value of SPF/
2 20
SIM 4-2 for the option trays.) RSPF for OC exposure.
The sensor of an uninstalled tray is not displayed. Used to set the AE and the limit value in AE
30
(Toner save).
Used to set the AE and the limit value in AE
31
(Toner save).
39 Used to switch the FAX send image quality.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 4
Code Code
Function Function
Main Sub Main Sub
Used to adjust the copy mode magnification ratio 1 Used to change and check the FAX-related soft SW.
1
(main scanning direction, sub scanning direction). Used to clear the FAX-related soft SW.
2
Used to adjust the scanner mode magnification (Except for the FAX adjustment values)
2
ratio (main/sub scanning direction). 3 FAX PWB memory check
48
Used to adjust the print mode magnification ratio 4 Signal send mode (Signal send level: Max.)
3
correction. 5 Signal send mode (Signal send level soft SW setting)
8 FAX magnification adjustment (read) 6 Printing the confidential password
9 FAX magnification adjustment (print) 7 Print the screen memory contents
1 Used to adjust the copy lead edge position. 10 Image data memory clear
Used to adjust the print image position (top margin) Used to send 300bps signals.
5 11
on the print paper in the print mode. (Signal send level: Max.)
Used to adjust the print image position (top margin) Used to send 300bps signals.
6 12
on print paper in the copy mode. (RSPF) (Signal send level: Set by soft SW)
8 FAX lead edge adjustment (read) 13 Used to register the dial numbers.
50
9 FAX lead edge adjustment (print) 14 Used to perform the dial test. (10 PPS send test)
Used to adjust the print image center position. 15 Used to perform the dial test. (20 PPS send test)
10 (Adjustment can be made for each paper feed 16 Used to perform the dial test. (DTFM signal send test)
section.) 66
Used to check the DTFM signal send operation.
Used to adjust the print image center position. 17
12 (Signal send level: Max.)
(Adjustment can be made for each document mode.)
Used to check the DTFM signal send operation.
1 Used to adjust the OPC drum separation pawl ON time. 18
(Signal send level: Set by soft SW.)
Used to adjust the contact pressure of paper onto 19 Used to write the SRAM data to the Flash ROM.
the resist roller in each section (copier paper feed
20 Used to write the Flash ROM data to the SRAM.
section, duplex paper feed section, RSPF paper
2 21 FAX information print
feed section). (When the print image position
22 Handset sound volume adjustment (Japan only)
51 varies greatly for the paper or when a lot of paper
jam troubles occur, the adjustment is required.) 24 Used to clear the FAST storage data. (SEC only)
Used to set the OPC drum separation pawl 30 Used to set the TEL/LIU.
8 31 Used to set the TEL/LIU.
operation inhibit. (ON/OFF)
Used to adjust the OPC drum separation voltage 32 Receive data check
9 33 Signal detection check
ON/OFF timing.
Used to adjust the detection level of the RSPF 34 Communication time measurement display
width. The adjustment method is the 4-point 37 Speaker sound volume adjustment
6 system. Set the guide to Max. (A3/WLetter) 41 CI signal check
position, A4R/Letter R position, A5R/Invoice R 52 Pseudo-ringer check
position, and Min. position for adjustment. Used to execute read/write check of the RAM on
Used to enter the RSPF width detection 1
7 the PCL board, and to display the result.
adjustment value. 14 Used to check write/comparison of flash programs.
Used to adjust the RSPF scan position of the Used to check the validity of the ROM on the PCL
53 15
mirror unit automatically. For the RSPF scan board and the result is displayed.
position automatic adjustment, the mirror unit is 67 Used to clear the printer section setting.
8 shifted to 11mm before the RSPF glass cover 17
(NVRAM clear)
edge, and is operated automatically to scan
Used to clear the data area for FLASH ROM
images by the unit of 1 step, detecting the position 18
Network Scanner Application.
up to the glass cover automatically.
Used to check the network connection when the
9 RSPF read position adjustment 20
scanner option is installed.
10 RSPF exp adjustment
55 1 Used to set the soft switch.
Used to check the LSU (polygon motor) operation.
61 1 Check speed can select 145mm/s or 122mm/s
individually.
Used to check the result of shading correction.
1
(The shading correction data are displayed.)
Used to adjust the RSPF white correction start
63
pixel position automatically.
7
This adjustment is performed after the lens unit is
replaced.
Used to check the operation of the printer function
64 1
(auto print operation).
Used to adjust the touch panel (LCD display
1
section) detection position.
65 Used to check the touch panel (LCD display
2
section) detection position adjustment result.
5 Used to check the key inputs of the operation panel.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 5
3. Details of simulation 2-2
Purpose Operation test/check
Function Used to check the operation of sensors and detectors
1 (Purpose) in the RSPF unit and the related circuit.
Section RSPF
Item Operation
1-1
Operation/procedure
Purpose Operation test/check
The operations of sensors and detectors in the RSPF section are dis-
Function Used to check the operation of the scanner unit and its
played.
(Purpose) control circuit.
Section Optical (Image scanning) The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.
Item Operation (For the original size, the detection result of the original size displayed
on the copy menu is highlighted.)
Operation/procedure
EMPS Original empty sensor
Enter the number of operations, and set the magnification ratio and the
DLS1 Original length sensor (Small)
original size.
DLS2 Original length sensor (Large)
1. Select the desired item, and press the [START] key. FGOD RSPF paper feed cover open/close sensor
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key. DFD RSPF paper entry sensor
The scanner unit operates at the speed corresponding to the set value. RDD RSPF original exit sensor
The scan counter is displayed during execution. OPCLS Book sensor
25% to 400% (1% increment) Original detection width sensor
Set magnification ratio SWD_LEN (Unit of 0.1mm. Width x 10 is displayed. Example: For
(Default 100%)
Document size Varies depending on the destination. 300mm, 3000 is displayed.)
Set number of times 1 to 999 (0: Continuous operation) SWD_A/D Original detection width sensor A/D value
RSPF width detection size (One of the following is displayed.)
1-2 A4/A3, LT/WLT, B5/B4, INV/LTR, A5/A4R, B5R, EXTRA, 8K/16K, 16KR
Note: Executable only when the RSPF is installed.
Purpose Operation test/check
Function Used to check the operation of sensor and detector in
2-3
(Purpose) the scanning (read) section and the related circuit.
Section Optical (Image scanning) Purpose Operation test/check
Item Operation Function Used to check the operation of the loads in the RSPF
(Purpose) unit and the control circuits.
Operation/procedure
Section RSPF
The status of sensors and detectors in the scanner section is dis-
Item Operation
played. The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.
MHPS Mirror home position sensor Operation/procedure
Select the load to be checked with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
The motor for 10sec, the solenoid ON for 500msec, OFF for 500msec.
(20 times)
2 Item Content
1 DTM-F RSPF motor forward rotation
2 DTM-R RSPF motor reverse rotation
2-1
3 DFCL RSPF paper feed clutch
Purpose Operation test/check 4 CLH RSPF PS clutch
Function Used to check the operation of the RSPF unit and the 5 GSOL Document exit gate solenoid
(Purpose) related circuit.
6 RSOL Document exit pressure solenoid
Section RSPF
Item Operation Note: Executable only when the RSPF is installed.
Operation/procedure
Enter the number of operations, and set the magnification ratio and the
original size.
1. Select the desired item, and press the [START] key.
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
The RSPF unit operates at the speed corresponding to the set value.
The scan counter is displayed during execution.
50% to 200% (1% increment)
Set magnification ratio
(Default 100%)
Document size Varies depending on the destination.
Duplex Selectable only when RSPF is installed.
Set number of times 1 to 999 (0: Continuous operation)
Note: Executable only when the RSPF is installed.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 6
3-10
3
Purpose Adjustment
3-2 Function
Used to make each adjustment of the finisher.
(Purpose)
Purpose Operation test/check
Item Operation
Function Used to check the operation of sensor and detector in
(Purpose) the finisher and the related circuit. Operation/procedure
Section Finisher 1. Select an item to be adjusted with 10-key, and press [START] key.
Item Operation 2. Enter an adjustment value with 10-key, and press [START] key.
Operation/procedure Installation
Item Content Default
Used to display the operations of sensors and detectors in the finisher range
section. Paper alignment
1 FPAM ADJUST 40-60 50
The active sensors and detectors are highlighted. width adjustment
FDTPD Paper delivery tray paper detector Paper delivery roller
FSTPD Staple tray paper detector 2 FDRLM ADJUST descending position 40-60 50
adjustment
FAPHPS-R Paper alignment plate HP sensor R
FAPHPS-F Paper alignment plate HP sensor F
FDRPS Delivery roller position sensor
FPPD1 Paper pass detector 3-11
FDTLLS Delivery tray lower limit sensor
Purpose Operation test/check
FTPS Tray position sensor
Used to check the shifter operation.
FPLD Paper level detector
Reciprocating operations are continuously performed
FSSW Safety switch Function
or the home position is checked.
FSLD Staple lead edge detector (Purpose)
(The shifter is shifted to the home position or moved in
FSED Staple empty detector one way by the specified steps.)
FSHPS Staple HP sensor Item Operation
FPRD Process tray paper rear edge detection
Operation/procedure
Note: Executable only when the finisher is installed. Select item 1, and press the [START] key.
The shifter is reciprocated continuously at the specified interval.
Item Content
3-3
1 F-R Reciprocating operation
Purpose Operation test/check 2 HP CHECK Home position check
Function Used to check the operation of the load in the finisher
[Selection 2]
(Purpose) and the control circuit.
Section Finisher 1. Select item 2, and press the [START] key.
Item Operation 2. Move the shifter to the home position or in one way by the specified
steps with the following keys.
Operation/procedure
[*] key Shifts the position toward R side by the specified steps.
Select the load to be checked with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
[0 key Shifts the position toward HP side by the specified steps.
The finisher main motor operates for 10sec, the staple motor 5 times,
[#] key Shifts to F.
the tray lift-up motor one reciprocating operation, other motors max. 20
SFTHP Shifter home position (At detection, highlighted)
reciprocating operations from the home position, the solenoid repeats
500msec ON and 500msec OFF 20 times.
The staple operation motor operates only when there is no cartridge
installed.
Item Content
1 FTLM Tray lift motor
2 FSM Staple motor
3 FPAM-R Paper alignment motor R
4 FPAM-F Paper alignment motor F
5 FPDM Paper delivery motor
6 FPS Paddle solenoid
7 FPTM Paper transport motor
8 FDRLM Delivery roller lift motor
9 FPGS Paper gate solenoid
10 FARLS Alignment roller lift solenoid
11 FSL Staple light
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 7
4 5
4-2 5-1
Purpose Operation test/check Purpose Operation test/check
Function Used to check the operation of sensor and detector in Function Used to check the operation of the display (LED), LCD
(Purpose) the option tray and the related circuit. (Purpose) in the operation panel, and control circuit.
Section Paper feed Section Operation (screen/operation)
Item Operation Item Operation
Operation/procedure Operation/procedure
The operating states of the sensor and the detector are displayed. The LCD is displayed as follows. (All LEDs are ON.)
(Only the installed option trays are displayed. For the standard tray, use With the upper half highlighted and the lower half normally displayed,
SIM 30-2.) contrast changes Standard MAX MIN. in every 2sec.
The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.
PED2 2nd tray paper empty sensor
LUD2 2nd tray paper upper limit detection sensor
PFD2 2nd tray paper pass sensor
CD2 2nd tray empty sensor
PED3 3rd tray paper empty sensor
LUD3 3rd tray paper upper limit detection sensor (6 sec later)
PFD3 3rd tray paper pass sensor With the upper half normally displayed and the lower half highlighted,
CD3 3rd tray empty sensor contrast changes Standard MAX MIN. in every 2sec.
PED4 4th tray paper empty sensor
LUD4 4th tray paper upper limit detection sensor
PFD4 4th tray paper pass sensor
CD4 4th tray empty sensor
DSWR2 2nd tray right door detection sensor
DSWR3 3rd tray right door detection sensor
DSWR4 4th tray right door detection sensor * When returning to the sub menu selection menu, the display of the
Note: Execution is possible only when the option tray is installed. standard contrast is displayed for an instant.
4-3 5-2
Operation/procedure Operation/procedure
Select the load to be checked with the 10-key, and press the [START] key. 1. Select the lamp to be checked with the 10-key, and press the
[START] key.
The motor for 10sec, the solenoid ON for 500msec, OFF for 500msec.
ON/OFF operation of the heater lamp is repeated 5 times in an interval
The lift-up motor operates only when the tray is opened. (20 times)
of 100ms/900ms.
Item Content When completing the operation, the cooling fan is rotated at a low speed.
1 LUM2 2nd tray lift-up motor Item Content
2 CPFC2 2nd tray pick-up solenoid
Item Content
3 CPFS2 2nd tray paper feed clutch
1 HL1 Heater lamp 1 (Main) operation
4 TRC2 2nd tray transport roller clutch
2 HL2 Heater lamp 2 (Sub) operation
2nd tray paper transport motor
5 DM
(3rd tray paper transport motor)
6 LUM3 3rd tray lift-up motor
5-3
7 CPFC3 3rd tray pick-up solenoid
8 CPFS3 3rd tray paper feed clutch Purpose Operation test/check
9 TRC3 3rd tray transport roller clutch Function Used to check the operation of the copy lamp and the
10 LUM4 4th tray lift-up motor (Purpose) control circuit.
11 CPFC4 4th tray pick-up solenoid Section Optical (Image scanning)
12 CPFS4 4th tray paper feed clutch Item Operation
Operation/procedure
Note: Execution is possible only when the option tray is installed.
When the [START] key is pressed, the copy lamp is lighted for 10sec.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 8
6 7
6-1 7-1
Purpose Operation test/check Purpose Setting/Operation test/check
Used to check the operation of the loads (clutches and Function (Purpose) Used to set the aging operation conditions.
Function
solenoids) in the paper transport system and the Item Operation
(Purpose)
control circuit. Operation/procedure
Section Paper transport (Discharge/Switchback/Transport)
1. Select the load to be set with the 10-key.
Item Operation
2. Press the [START] key.
Operation/procedure
When selected without setup, the selected value is registered and
1. Select the load to be checked with the 10-key, and press the highlighted. When selected with previous setup, the previous setup is
[START] key. canceled and it is displayed normally.
The motor for 10sec, the solenoid ON for 500msec, OFF for 500msec. Press [CA] key, and the simulation will be terminated and the machine
(20 times) goes into the aging standby mode with the set content.
When the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] is pressed, the operation is interrupted. This setting is canceled by power OFF.
The lift-up motor operates only when the tray is opened.
Item Content
Item Content 1 AGING Aging enable/disable setting
1 LUM1 1st tray lift-up motor 2 MISFEED Jam detection enable/disable setting
2 CPFC1 1st tray pick-up solenoid Fusing operation enable/disable setting
3 CPFS1 1st tray paper feed clutch 3 FUSING*1 The fusing temperature is not controlled.
4 MPFS Manual feed pick-up solenoid The heater is not turned ON.
5 RRC Resist roller clutch 4 INTERVL Intermittent setting (Valid only when set to AGING.)
6 PSPS Separation pawl solenoid Warm-up save setting
7 OGS Paper exit gate switching solenoid The machine goes into the ready state only by
8 LUM2 2nd tray lift-up motor 5 WARMUP shading, disregarding fusing and process control.
9 CPFC2 2nd tray pick-up solenoid After going into the ready state, normal control is
performed.
10 CPFS2 2nd tray paper feed clutch
11 TRC2 2nd tray transport roller clutch 6 DV CHK. Developing unit detection enable/disable setting
12 LUM3 3rd tray lift-up motor *1: When the machine exits from the fusing ignoring state, the roller may
13 CPFC3 3rd tray pick-up solenoid be cooled down. Therefore, reset the machine to warm up again.
14 CPFS3 3rd tray paper feed clutch When, therefore, the simulation is canceled by pressing the [CA]
15 TRC3 3rd tray transport roller clutch key or when the copy mode display is shifted to the initial menu dis-
play in the simulation mode of one page copy, the machine is reset.
16 LUM4 4th tray lift-up motor
17 CPFC4 4th tray pick-up solenoid Note: In SIM 7-1, pressing [CA] key terminates the simulation and the
18 CPFS4 4th tray paper feed clutch machine enters the aging mode without resetting. Therefore, to
perform 4. Intermittent setup, the intermittent cycle must be set
19 ROGS Right paper exit gate solenoid
with SIM 7-6 in advance.
The lift-up motor operates only when the tray is opened. Reset is not performed when the machine enters the aging mode.
6-2 7-6
Purpose Operation test/check Purpose Setting/Operation test/check
Function Used to check the operation of each fan motor and its Function (Purpose) Used to set the cycle of intermittent aging.
(Purpose) control circuit. Item Operation
Section Others
Operation/procedure
Item Operation
1. Enter the interval aging cycle time (sec) with the 10-key pad.
Operation/procedure Refer to SIM 7-1.
Select the load to be checked with the 10-key, and press the [START] key. 2. Press the [START] key.
The selected load is operated for 10sec. When the [START] key is pressed in aging, copying is performed con-
Item Content tinuously. This simulation is used to set the time interval between copy
1 VFM Fusing fan operates operations in the unit of second.
Power cooling fan, power cooling fan 2 This setting is valid when SIM 7-1 (Intermittent setting) is enabled.
2 DCFM&DCFM2
operations Setting range 1-255
3 VFM2 Fusing exit paper fan operates Default 3
Fusing fan, power cooling fan, and
VFM&DCFM&DCFM2
3 power cooling fan 2 are operated at the
&VFM2
same time.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 9
7-8 8-2
Purpose Setting/Operation test/check Purpose Adjustment/Operation test/check
Function Used to check and adjust the operation of the main
Used to set the display of the warm-up time. Function
(Purpose) charger grid voltage in each copy mode and the control
(Purpose)
Item Operation circuit.
Operation/procedure Image process
Section (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
1. Warm-up starts by the cover open/close.
Photo conductor
(Can be performed repeatedly by open/close of the cover.)
Operation/procedure
2. The warm-up time is counted up and displayed in the unit of sec.
1. Touch the exposure mode to be changed.
If the [CA] key is pressed at this time, count-up is interrupted to ter-
The current set value is displayed.
minate the simulation. (However, warm-up is continued.)
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
3. After completion of warming up, WARM UP COMPLETED is dis-
played and the control returns to the initial screen. 3. Press the [START] key.
Output is made with the entered value for 30sec, and the display
returns to the original state.
8 Item Content
Setting
Default
range
1 AE (145) AE (145mm/s) 590
8-1
2 TEXT (145) Character (145mm/s) 590
Purpose Adjustment/Operation test/check
Character/Photo
Used to check and adjust the operation of the 3 TEXT/PHOTO (145) 590
Function (145mm/s)
developing bias voltage in each copy mode and the
(Purpose) 4 PHOTO (145) Photo (145mm/s) 590
control circuit.
Image process 5 TONER SAVE (145) Toner save (145mm/s) 350- 540
Section (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning) 6 AE (122) AE (122mm/s) 750 590
Developer/Toner hopper
7 TEXT (122) Character (122mm/s) 590
Operation/procedure Character/Photo
1. Touch the exposure mode to be changed. 8 TEXT/PHOTO (122) 590
(122mm/s)
The current set value is displayed.
9 PHOTO (122) Photo (122mm/s) 590
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
10 TONER SAVE (122) Toner save (122mm/s) 540
3. Press the [START] key.
Output is made with the entered value, and the display returns to the Min. unit: 10V increment
original state.
() Linked with the destinations of SIM 26-6.
Setting Linked with the auto exposure mode of SIM 46-19-1.
Item Content Default
range
1 AE (145) AE (145mm/s) 450 8-10
2 TEXT (145) Character (145mm/s) 450
Purpose Adjustment/Operation test/check
Character/Photo
3 TEXT/PHOTO (145) 450 Used to check and adjust the operation of the
(145mm/s) Function
developing bias voltage in each printer mode and the
4 PHOTO (145) Photo (145mm/s) 450 (Purpose)
control circuit.
5 TONER SAVE (145) Toner save (145mm/s) 200- 400
Image process
6 AE (122) AE (122mm/s) 650 450
Section (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
7 TEXT (122) Character (122mm/s) 450
Developer/Toner hopper
Character/Photo
8 TEXT/PHOTO (122) 450
(122mm/s) Operation/procedure
9 PHOTO (122) Photo (122mm/s) 450 1. Touch the exposure mode to be changed.
10 TONER SAVE (122) Toner save (122mm/s) 400 The current set value is displayed.
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
() Linked with the destinations of SIM 26-6.
Linked with the auto exposure mode of SIM 46-19-1. 3. Press the [START] key.
The minimum increment is 10V.
The result of (Set value) -200/ 10 is stored in the EEPROM.
When reading a value from the EEPROM, the value of (EEP value
*10+200) is used as the set value.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 10
Output is made with the entered value for 30sec, and the display 8-13
returns to the original state.
Purpose Adjustment/Operation test/check
Installa
Used to check and adjust the operation of the
Item Content tion Default Function
developing bias voltage in FAX mode and the control
range (Purpose)
circuit.
1 DENS1 (145) Density1 (145mm/s) 300
Image process
2 DENS2 (145) Density2 (145mm/s) 370 Section (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
3 DENS3 (145) Density3 (145mm/s) 420 Developer/Toner hopper
4 DENS4 (145) Density4 (145mm/s) 530 Operation/procedure
5 DENS5 (145) Density5 (145mm/s) 600 1. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
6 TS (145) Toner save (145mm/s) 200- 250 2. Press the [START] key.
7 DENS1 (122) Density1 (122mm/s) 650 300 Output is made with the entered value for 30sec. and the display
8 DENS2 (122) Density2 (122mm/s) 370 returns to the original state.
9 DENS3 (122) Density3 (122mm/s) 420 Setting range 200-650
10 DENS4 (122) Density4 (122mm/s) 530 Default 450
11 DENS5 (122) Density5 (122mm/s) 600
The minimum increment is 10V.
12 TS (122) Toner save (122mm/s) 250 The result of (Set value-200) / 10 is stored in the EEPROM.
When reading a value from the EEPROM, the value of (EEP value 10
The minimum increment is 10V.
The result of (Set value) -200/ 10 is stored in the EEPROM. +200) is used as the set value.
When reading a value from the EEPROM, the value of (EEP value Therefore, an even number must be entered. If not, the entered odd
number +1 is displayed after pressing [START] key.
*10+200) is used as the set value.
8-14
8-11
Purpose Adjustment/Operation test/check Purpose Adjustment/Operation test/check
Used to check and adjust the operation of the main Used to check and adjust the operation of the main
Function
Function charger grid voltage in FAX mode and the control
charger grid voltage in each printer mode and the (Purpose)
(Purpose) circuit.
control circuit.
Image process Image process
Section (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
Section (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
Photo conductor Photo conductor
Operation/procedure Operation/procedure
1. Touch the exposure mode to be changed. 1. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
The current set value is highlighted. 2. Press the [START] key.
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key. Output is made with the entered value for 30sec. and the display
returns to the original state.
3. Press the [START] key.
Output is made with the entered value for 30sec, and the display Setting range 350-750
returns to the original state. Default 590
Installa
Item Content tion Default
range
1 DENS1 (145) Density 1 (145mm/s) 440 9
2 DENS2 (145) Density 2 (145mm/s) 510
3 DENS3 (145) Density 3 (145mm/s) 560 9-1
4 DENS4 (145) Density 4 (145mm/s) 670
Purpose Operation test/check
5 DENS5 (145) Density 5 (145mm/s) 740 Function Used to check and adjust the operation of the load
6 TS (145) Toner save (145mm/s) 350- 390 (Purpose) (motor) in the duplex section and the control circuit.
7 DENS1 (122) Density 1 (122mm/s) 750 440 Section Duplex
8 DENS2 (122) Density 2 (122mm/s) 510 Item Operation
9 DENS3 (122) Density 3 (122mm/s) 560 Operation/procedure
10 DENS4 (122) Density 4 (122mm/s) 670 1. Select the operation mode with the 10-key.
11 DENS5 (122) Density 5 (122mm/s) 740 2. Press the [START] key.
12 TS (122) Toner save (122mm/s) 390 The operation is performed for 30sec, and the display returns to the
original state.
Min. unit: 10V increment
Item Content
Duplex motor/Duplex 2 motor forward rotation
1 DMF145
(145mm/s)
Duplex motor/Duplex 2 motor forward rotation
2 DMF122
(122mm/s)
Duplex motor/Duplex 2 motor reverse rotation
3 DMR145
(145mm/s)
Duplex motor/Duplex 2 motor reverse rotation
4 DMR122
(122mm/s)
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 11
9-4
16
Purpose Operation test/check
Function (Purpose) Duplex motor RPM setting
16-0
Section Duplex
Item Operation Purpose Clear/Cancel (Trouble etc.)
Function (Purpose) Used to cancel the self-diag U2 trouble.
Operation/procedure
Item Trouble Error
Enter the set value with the 10-key.
Operation/procedure
When the duplex motor setting is made, the duplex 2motor is also set
accordingly. 1. Press the [START] key.
2. When 1: YES is selected, U2 trouble is canceled.
Setting range 1-13
(When 2: NO is selected, the simulation is canceled.)
Default 5
9-5
17
Purpose Adjustment
Used to adjust the timing of switching from normal 17-0
Function
rotation to reverse rotation or from reverse rotation to
(Purpose) Purpose Cancel (Trouble, etc)
normal rotation of the duplex motor.
Function (Purpose) Used to cancel the self diag PF trouble.
Operation/procedure
Item Trouble Error
1. Touch the item to set.
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key. Operation/Procedure
1. Press the [START] key.
Item Installation range Default
1 145mm/s 18 2. When 1: YES is selected, PF trouble is canceled. (When 2: NO
2 122mm/s 18 is selected, the simulation is canceled.)
18-76
3 RIGHT 145mm/s 50
4 RIGHT 122mm/s 50
21
21-1
10
Purpose Setting
Function (Purpose) Used to set the maintenance cycle.
10-0
Item Specifications Counter
Purpose Operation test/check
Operation/procedure
Function Used to check the operation of the toner motor and its
1. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
(Purpose) control circuit.
Image process 2. Press the [START] key.
Section (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning) Content
Item
Developer/Toner hopper 26cpm 31cpm
Item Operation 0 5K 5K
Operation/procedure 1 10K 10K
2 20K 50K
Press the [START] key and operate the toner motor for 30 sec.
3 25K 75K
4 50K 100K
5 75K (Default) 150K (Default) *
14 6 FREE FREE
* When selecting 150K, maintenance message is displayed by imple-
14-0 menting the following conditions.
Purpose Clear/Cancel (Trouble etc.) Maintenance count = 150K.
Function DV count = 100K
Used to cancel excluding the self-diag U2/PF troubles.
(Purpose) DR count = 100K
Item Trouble Error * When maintenance message is displayed, replace consumption part
Operation/procedure reaching the number of sheets of maintenance, then clear the
replaced part's counter only.
1. Press the [START] key.
2. When 1: YES is selected, troubles other than U2 and PF are can-
celed. (When 2: NO is selected, the simulation is canceled.)
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 12
Item Jam contents
22 TRAY2 2nd tray pick-up miss
TRAY3 3rd tray pick-up miss
22-1 TRAY4 4th tray pick-up miss
Adjustment/setting/operation data output/check BPT Multi manual feed pick-up miss
Purpose PPD1_ND Paper-in sensor lead edge jam
(display/print)
Function PPD1_ST Paper-in sensor rear edge jam
Used to check the counter value of each section. PPD1_DUP Paper-in sensor reverse jam
(Purpose)
Item Counter PPD2_ND Duplex sensor lead edge jam
PPD2_ST Duplex sensor rear edge jam
Operation/procedure
POD2_ND Upper tray paper exit lead edge jam
Each counter is displayed. POD2_ST Upper tray paper exit rear edge jam
TOTAL Total counter POD1_ND Lower tray paper exit lead edge jam
MAINTENANCE Maintenance counter POD1_ST Lower tray paper exit rear edge jam
DEVE Developer counter PINT_SHORT Abnormality between PS papers.
DRUM Drum counter PFD2_ND 2nd paper pass lead edge jam
COPY Copy counter PFD2_ST 2nd paper pass rear edge jam
PRINTER Printer counter PFD3_ND 3rd paper pass lead edge jam
IMC IMC counter PFD3_ST 3rd paper pass rear edge jam
DUPLEX Duplex counter PFD4_ND 4th paper pass lead edge jam
OTHERS The other counters PFD4_ST 4th paper pass rear edge jam
SIZE_SHORT Duplex short scale error
FAX SEND FAX Send counter
FPPD1_N Finisher entry port sensor not-reached jam
FAX RCV FAX receive counter
FPPD1_S Finisher entry port sensor remaining jam
FAX OUTPUT FAX print counter
FSTPD_S Finisher paper exit remaining jam
DEVE RANGE Developer traveling distance counter
FSTPLJ Finisher staple jam
DRUM RANGE Drum traveling distance counter
DEVE ROLL Developer rotation counter (K)
DRUM ROLL Drum rotation counter (K) 22-4
DEVE LIFE Developer life meter (%)
Adjustment/setting/operation data output/check
DRUM LIFE Drum life meter (%) Purpose
(display/print)
Function
Used to check the total trouble (self diag) history.
(Purpose)
22-2 Item Trouble
22-3 The display of the protocol monitor and the soft SW follows this display.
S/N Machine serial number
Adjustment/setting/operation data output/check
Purpose MCU Main Control Unit
(display/print)
Used to check the misfeed positions and the number of IMC IMC
Function misfeed at each position. (When the number of OPE Panel + Panel label code
(Purpose) misfeed is considerably great, it can be judged as PRINTER PRINTER
necessary for repair.) NIC NIC
Item Trouble Mis-feed
FINISHER FINISHER
Operation/procedure FAX FAX
The misfeed history is displayed in the sequence of recentness by the PUNCH
Punch unit
name of sensors and detectors. Max. 40 items of information can be UNIT
stored in memory. (The old ones are deleted sequentially.) The trouble
section may be determined by the data. If it is not installed, - - - - - - - - - - is displayed.
(Jam cause code) Panel
Destination Panel software support language
display
Item Jam contents
TRAY1 1st tray pick-up miss JPN Japan Japanese, American English, English
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 13
Panel 22-7
Destination Panel software support language
display
Purpose User data output/Check (Display/Print)
SEC
Function
SECL Used to display of the administrator password.
(Purpose)
SUK American English, English, French, Spanish, Item Data User data
EFS
SCA/SCNZ Brazilian Portuguese
Operation/procedure
Distributor
Used to display the administrator password.
area
SEEG/
English, German, Polish, Czech, Hungarian, 22-8
SEA/East
EEU Greek, Turkish, Russian, French, Italian,
Europe, Adjustment/setting/operation data output/check
Slovak Purpose
etc. (display/print)
SEF/ Function
English, German, French, Spanish, Dutch, Used to display the original, staple counter.
SEES/ (Purpose)
NEU Italian, Portuguese, Swedish, Norwegian,
SEIS/SEN, Item Counter
Finnish, Danish
etc.
Operation/procedure
Simplified Chinese, American English,
CHN SOCC Each counter is displayed.
English
Traditional Chinese (Local support), SPF RSPF counter
TWN Taiwan SCAN Scan counter
American English, English
Saudi American English, English, French, Spanish, STAPLE Stapler counter
ARB
Arabia Hebrew (Local support), Arabic The counter display is in 7 digits.
FAS Iran English, Arabic, Persian
22-9
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 14
Item Display items Paper Reached/
ICCARDR/W NONE/MX-ECX2 Error code Name Sensor name Not Reached to
NONE: When it is not installed, - - - - - - - - - - is displayed. the sensor
SPF P-OUT
[ ]: Shows the product code in the list below. Reached
RSPF long size sensor
No. Item Model code ORG_LONG
error SPF P-IN
1 RSPF MX-RP10 Reached
sensor
2 Finisher MX-FN13
3 Job separator MX-TR11
4 1 tray paper feed unit MX-DE10 (*1)
22-13
5 2 tray paper feed unit MX-DE11 (*1)
6 PRINTER MX-PB12 Adjustment/setting/operation data output/check
Purpose
7 PS3 MX-PK10 (display/print)
8 NIC STANDARD (Only SoftNic) Function
Used to display the CRUM type.
9 SCANNER MX-NSX1 (Purpose)
10 FAX AR-FX7 Item Specifications
11 Handset AR-HN4
Operation/Procedure
*1: The number of installed units is displayed beside the model code. Used to display the CRUM type.
For the tray, only the option tray is displayed. Item Content
00 Not fixed.
01 AR-A
22-11
02 AR-B
Adjustment/setting/operation data output/check 03 AR-C
Purpose
(display/print) 04 China
Function Used to display the FAX send/receive counter 05 Japan
(Purpose) (FAX reception and print counter).
99 Conversion completed.
Section FAX
Item Counter
Operation/procedure 22-19
Used to display the FAX send/receive counter. Adjustment/setting/operation data output/check
Purpose
FAX SEND PAGE/TIME FAX send page and time (display/print)
FAX RECEIVE PAGE/TIME FAX receive page and time Function Used to display the scanner counter in the network
FAX OUTPUT FAX output (number of print) (Purpose) scanner mode.
Section Network scanner
The counter display is in 8 digits.
Item Counter
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
Operation/procedure
22-12 Used to display the scanner counter.
SCANMODE Scanner mode counter
Adjustment/setting/operation data output/check
Purpose
(display/print) The counter display is in 7 digits.
Used to check the misfeed positions and the number of
Function misfeed at each position.
(Purpose) (When the number of misfeed is considerably great, it
can be judged as necessary for repair.) 24
Section RSPF
Item Trouble Misfeed
24-1
Operation/procedure
Purpose Data clear
Used to display the RSPF jam history data sequentially from the latest Used to clear the misfeed counter, the misfeed history,
one. Function
the trouble counter, and the trouble history. (The
Forty RSPF jam histories are displayed sequentially from the latest. (Purpose)
counters are cleared after completion of maintenance.)
Paper Reached/ Section Memory
Error code Name Sensor name Not Reached to Item Counter
the sensor
Operation/procedure
RSPF paper in lead SPF P-IN
DFD_ND Not Reached Jam/trouble counter is cleared individually. (The history of each
edge jam sensor
counter is deleted when clearing)
RSPF paper in rear SPF P-IN
DFD_ST Reached 1. Select the counter to be cleared with the 10-key.
edge jam sensor
Reached, 2. Press the [START] key.
RSPF paper out SPF P-IN The confirmation menu is shown.
RDD_ND P_OUT Not
lead edge jam sensor
Reached 3. Select 1: YES.
RSPF paper out SPF P-OUT Reached, P_IN 1: YES (Cleared)
RDD_ST
rear edge jam sensor passed (OFF) 2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
Not Reached Item Content
RSPF duplex SPF P-IN
JAM_REV (Paper after 1 JAM JAM counter/JAM history
reverse jam sensor
reversing) 2 SPF JAM RSPF JAM counter/RSPF JAM history
RSPF short size SPF P-IN Passed (OFF at 3 TROUBLE Trouble counter/Trouble history
ORG_SHORT
error sensor JAM)
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 15
24-2 24-5
Purpose Data clear Purpose Data clear
Function Used to clear the number of use (the number of prints) Function Used to reset the developer counter. (The developer
(Purpose) of each paper feed section. (Purpose) counter of the DV unit which is installed is reset.)
Section Paper feed Section Image process
Item Counter (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
Operation/procedure Developer/Toner hopper
Item Counter Developer
Used to clear each paper feed counter individually.
1. Select the counter to be cleared with the 10-key. Operation/procedure
2. Press the [START] key. The confirmation menu is shown. 1. Press the [START] key.
The confirmation menu is shown.
3. Select 1: YES.
2. Select 1: YES.
1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default) 1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
Item Content
1 BYPASS Manual feed counter
2 TRAY1 Tray 1 counter 24-6
3 TRAY2 Tray 2 counter
Purpose Data clear
4 TRAY3 Tray 3 counter
Function (Purpose) Used to clear the copy counter.
5 TRAY4 Tray 4 counter
Item Counter Copier
Operation/procedure
24-3 1. Press the [START] key.
Purpose Data clear The confirmation menu is shown.
Function Used to clear the number usage data of the stapler, 2. Select 1: YES.
(Purpose) RSPF, and scanning. 1: YES (Cleared)
Section Transport/Finisher 2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
Item Counter
Operation/procedure 24-7
Used to clear the original and staple counters individually. Purpose Data clear
1. Select the counter to be cleared with the 10-key. Used to clear the OPC drum (membrane decrease)
Function
2. Press the [START] key. correction counter. (This simulation is executed when
(Purpose)
The confirmation menu is shown. the OPC drum is replaced.)
Image process
3. Select 1: YES.
Section (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
1: YES (Cleared)
Photo conductor
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
Item Counter
Item Content
1 SPF RSPF counter Operation/procedure
2 SCAN Scan counter 1. Press the [START] key.
3 STAPLE Stapler counter The confirmation menu is shown.
2. Select 1: YES.
1: YES (Cleared)
24-4
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
Purpose Data clear
Function (Purpose) Used to reset the maintenance counter. 24-9
Item Counter
Purpose Data clear
Operation/procedure Function
1. Press the [START] key. The confirmation menu is shown. Used to clear the printer counter and other counters.
(Purpose)
2. Select 1: YES. Section Printer
1: YES (Cleared) Item Counter Printer
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
Operation/procedure
1. Select the counter to be cleared with the 10-key.
2. Press the [START] key.
The confirmation menu is shown.
3. Select 1: YES.
1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
Item Content
1 PRINTER Printer counter
2 IMC IMC counter
3 DUPLEX DUPLEX counter
4 OTHERS The other counters
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 16
24-10 25-2
Purpose Data clear Purpose Setting
Function (Purpose) FAX counter data clear Function Used to make the initial setting of toner concentration
Section FAX (Purpose) when replacing developer.
Item Counter Image process
Operation/procedure Section (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
Developer/Toner hopper
1. Select the 3: NUMBER OF PRINTS, and press the [START] key.
The confirmation menu is shown. Operation/procedure
2. Select 1: YES. 1) Open the cover with the power OFF.
1: YES (Cleared) 2) Turn on the power. (Since the cover is open, the machine does not
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default) perform initializing.)
Item Content 3) Execute the simulation.
FAX SEND 4) Enter SIM 25-2. ([25] [START] key [2] [START] key)
1 FAX send page and time
(PAGE & TIME) 5) Close the cover just before starting the simulation.
FAX RECEIVE 6) Press the [START] key.
2 FAX receive page and time
(PAGE & TIME)
The main motor rotates. After stirring for 3 min, the toner density
3 FAX OUTPUT FAX output (number of prints)
control sensor value is sampled 16 times, and the average value is
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed. stored.
When EE-EU or EE-EL after completion, an error display is shown.
24-15 Note: After completion of execution, be sure to press the [CA] key to
cancel the simulation.
Purpose Data clear
Function Used to clear the scanner counter in the network
(Purpose) scanner mode.
Section Scanner section 26
Item Counter
Operation/procedure 26-1
1. Press the [START] key. Purpose Setting
The confirmation menu is shown. Used to set whether the job separator is installed or
Function
2. Select 1: YES. not. (Since this cannot be detected by hardware
(Purpose)
1: YES (Cleared) detection, it is set in this simulation.)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default) Item Specifications Option
The scanner mode counter and the number of send of the scanner are Operation/procedure
cleared.
1. Select the set value with the 10-key.
* The simulation to perform communication with the PCL is inhibited
2. Press the [START] key.
until Notice Page storing is completed. (Only when the serviceman
call error occurs.) Set value Connection option
0 None (default)
* When in other than the serviceman call error, entering the simulation
is not allowed from the system check display. 1 Job separator provided.
26-2
25
Purpose Setting
Function Used to set whether the automatic detection of paper
25-1 (Purpose) size is made or not.
Purpose Operation test/check Section Paper feed
Used to check the operation of the main drive Item Specifications
Function (excluding the scanner section) and to check the
Operation/procedure
(Purpose) operation of the toner concentration sensor. (The toner
concentration sensor output can be monitored.) 1. Select the item with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
Used to set the automatic size detection.
Section DRIVE
2. Set whether automatic detection of paper size is made or not with
Item Operation
the 10-key.
Operation/procedure Setting to detect B4/Legal as FC
1. Press the [START] key. 1:B4/LG,FC 0: B4 legal is detected as B4 legal. (Default)
The main motor rotates to start monitoring the toner density control 1: B4 legal is detected as FC.
sensor. (3min operation) This setup detects Letter as A4 in the inch series and
* Even in toner end error, if there is no other error (including cover A4 as Letter in the AB series.
2:A4<->LT
open) after turning on the power, this simulation can be performed. 0: Detection disable (Default)
1: Detection valid
8.5 x 13 detection valid/invalid setup
Set value Setup Remarks
0 Detection invalid Default
1 Detection valid
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 17
Detection size when 8.5 x 13 document/paper is used. Operation/procedure
Set value Select the mode corresponding to the auditor specification mode with
Employed Destina Document
0 1 the 10-key.
unit tion size
(Invalid) (Valid)
FC FC Setting
B4 Item Content Default
(8.5 x 13) (8.5 x 13) range
AB LG FC 0 P10 Built-in auditor mode
B4
series (8.5 x 14) (8.5 x 13) 1 VENDOR Coin vendor mode 0-2 0
FC
Document B4 B4 2 OTHER Others
Docu (8.5 x 13)
table/
ment FC LG FC When 1: VENDOR (Coin vendor mode) is set, the following three
RSPF
(8.5 x 13) (8.5 x 14) (8.5 x 13) items of key operation setting are changed.
Inch LG LG FC 1) Set the LCD backlight change inhibit to 1: OFF (Enable).
series (8.5 x 14) (8.5 x 14) (8.5 x 13)
2) When SIM 26-6 destination setting is set to 0: Japan, duplex copy
WLT WLT
B4 inhibit setting must be set to 0: ON (Inhibit).
(11 x 17) (11 x 17)
Machine All 3) Set the sort automatic selection to 0: OFF (Disable).
paper feed destina Set with key operations.
tray tions
FC LG FC 26-5
(8.5 x 13) (8.5 x 14) (8.5 x 13)
AB Purpose Setting
LG LG FC
series Function Used to set the count mode of the total counter and the
Paper (8.5 x 14) (8.5 x 14) (8.5 x 13)
Manual (Purpose) maintenance counter.
B4 B4 B4
paper feed Item Specifications Counter
FC LG FC
tray
(8.5 x 13) (8.5 x 14) (8.5 x 13) Operation/procedure
Inch
LG LG FC
series Used to set the count up number (1 or 2) when an A3/WLT paper
(8.5 x 14) (8.5 x 14) (8.5 x 13)
passes through.
B4 B4 B4
For the drum counter and the developer counter, double count is
A4/LT (8.5 x 11) detection enable/disable setup employed unconditionally.
In the inch series, Letter is detected as A4; in the AB series, A4 is (Target counter selection)
detected as Letter.
Item Content
Set value Setup Remarks
1 TOTAL COUNTER Total counter
0 Detection invalid Default
1 Detection valid 2 MAINTENANCE COUNTER Maintenance counter
Detection size when A4/LT (8.5 x 11) document/paper is used. Used to set the count up number of the selected counter.
Set value Item Content Setting range Default
Employed Destina Document
0 1 1 SINGLE COUNT Single count
unit tion size 1-2 2
(Invalid) (Valid) 2 DOUBLE COUNT Double count
LT
A4 A4
AB (8.5 x 11)
series LT LT
Document A4 26-6
Docu (8.5 x 11) (8.5 x 11)
table/
ment LT Purpose Setting
RSPF A4 A4
Inch (8.5 x 11) Function Used to set the specifications depending on the
series LT LT (Purpose) destination.
A4
(8.5 x 11) (8.5 x 11) Item Specifications Destination
Machine All
Set with key Operation/procedure
paper feed destina
operations.
tray tions Select the destination with the 10-key.
Paper
Manual All By changing the destination, some other setting items may be changed.
Regardless of the
paper feed destina
simulation setup. Setting
tray tions Item Content Default
range
0 JAPAN Japan
1 SEC SEC
26-3
2 SECL SECL
Purpose Setting 3 SEEG SEEG
Used to set the specifications of the auditor. 4 SUK SUK
Function
Setting must be made depending on the use condition 5 SCA SCA
(Purpose)
of the auditor. 6 SEF SEF
Section Auditor 7 INEG EX inch series 0-14 0
Item Specifications 8 ABEG EX AB series
9 INEF EX inch series (FC)
10 ABEF EX AB series (FC)
11 CHINESE China
12 TAIWAN Taiwan AB
13 SEEG2 SEEG2
14 TAIWAN2 Taiwan China
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 18
26-10 Operation/procedure
The current setup is displayed with ON or OFF.
Purpose Setting
Enter an input (20 digits) of the PS expansion kit soft key with the 10-
Function (Purpose) Network scanner trial mode setting
key and press the [START] key, and the collating result is displayed
Section Scanner
with OK or NG.
Operation/procedure After canceling the simulation, if OK, the PS expansion kit function is
Enter the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key. enable; if NG, the PS expansion kit function is disabled.
Item Content Default This setting must be reset after the simulation cancel.
0 END Trail mode cancel Note: Executable only when the PCL/PS3 is installed.
0
1 START Trial mode start
If the trial scanner counter value is less than 500, the trial mode setting 26-18
can be repeatedly made. If the scanner trial counter value is 500 or Purpose Setting
more, the trial mode setting cannot be made. Function
Used to set enable/disable of toner save operation.
When the scanner is not set and the scanner trial counter value is less (Purpose)
than 500, if 1 is entered in SIM26-10, the trial mode setting is started. Item Specifications Operation mode (Common)
If 0 is entered in SIM26-10, the trial mode setting is canceled.
Operation/procedure
After recognition of the scanner, the trial mode setting cannot be made. Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
(Entering 1 is invalid and a beep sound is produced.)
Setting
When this setting is made, the machine must be reset after canceling Item Content Default
range
the simulation. When 1: Trial mode start is selected, the scanner 0 OFF Disable
function is valid. If 0: Trial mode cancel is selected, the scanner func- 0-1 0
1 ON Enable
tion is invalid.
Note: Setup is allowed only for Japan and UK.
When setting is invalid (when the scanner is recognized or the scanner
trial counter value is 500 or more) in the key operations of the trail
mode setting, an invalid sound (beep sound) is made. In the other 26-22
case, a valid sound is made.
Purpose Setting
* When the scanner trial counter value is changed from 500 or more to
Function Used to set the specification (language display) for the
less than 500, the trail setting is changed from END to SETTING
(Purpose) destination.
START.
Item Specifications
Note: Executable only when the PCL/SCANNER is installed.
Operation/procedure
Select the display language with the 10-key, and press the [START]
26-12 key.
Purpose Setting This setup varies in connection with SIM 26-6 (Destination setup).
Function Item Remarks
Used to input the Software Key for E-MAIL RIC.
(Purpose) 0 JAPANESE
Section E-MAIL RIC 1 ENG.US
Item Specifications 2 ENG.UK
3 FRENCH
Operation/procedure 4 GERMAN
The current setup is displayed with ON or OFF. 5 ITALY
Enter an input (20 digits) of the E-MAIL RIC soft key with the 10-key 6 DUTCH
and press the [START] key, and the collating result is displayed with OK 7 SWEDISH
or NG. 8 SPANISH
After canceling the simulation, if OK, the E-MAIL RIC function is 9 PORTUGUESE
enable; if NG, the E-MAIL RIC function is disabled. 10 TURKISH
11 GREEK
This setting must be reset after the simulation cancel.
12 POLISH
* If recognition is OK, the E-Mail RIC can be set to Enable. If the FAX 13 HUNGARIAN
is installed, however, the operation cannot be made actually. 14 CZECH
Note: Executable only when the PCL/NIC is installed. 15 RUSSIAN
16 FINNISH
17 NORWEGIAN
26-14 18 DANISH
19 CHINESE
Purpose Setting
20 TAIWANESE Traditional Chinese supported locally
Function
Used to input the Software Key for the PS extention kit. 21 SLOVAK
(Purpose)
22 HEBREW Supported locally
Section Printer BRAZILIAN
Item Specifications 23
PORTUGUESE
24 ARABIC
25 FARSI
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 19
26-30 26-56
Purpose Setting Purpose Setting
Function Used to set ON/OFF of the heater lamp slow-up control Function (Purpose) Gamma life correction setting
(Purpose) conforming to the CE mark control. Item Operation
Item Specifications Operation mode (Common) Operation/procedure
Operation/procedure Sets enable/disable of the gamma life correction function.
Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key. Item Set value Default
This setup varies in connection with SIM 26-6 (Destination setup). 1 AE (Japan) 0
Default 2 AE (Ex Japan) 0
Item
U.S.A, Canada, Australia, France, Taiwan Others 3 Text 1
0 OFF 4 Text/Photo 1
0 1
1 ON 5 Photo (Error diffusion) 0: Disable 1
6 Photo (Dither) 1: Enable 1
7 T/S AE (Japan) 0
26-35 8 T/S AE (Ex Japan) 0
Purpose Setup 9 T/S Text 1
Used to set whether the same continuous troubles are 10 T/S Text/Photo 1
Function
displayed as one trouble or the series of troubles with
(Purpose)
SIM 22-4 when the same troubles occur continuously.
Item Specifications 26-57
Operation/procedure Purpose Setting
Enter the set value with 10-key, and press [START] key. Function (Purpose) Used to set the model code.
Item Content Default Item Operation
When two or more troubles occur, only one is Operation/procedure
0 ONCE
registered. 0 Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
1 ANY All the troubles occurred are registered.
Item Default
1 MX-M260N
2 MX-M310N
26-36
3 MX-M260
Purpose Setting 4 MX-M310
1
Function Used to set whether the machine is stopped or not 5 MX-M260FG
(Purpose) when the maintenance counter life is expired. 6 MX-M260FP
Item Operation 7 MX-M310FG
8 MX-M310FP
Operation/procedure
Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
Item Content Default 26-60
0 STOP Stop
1 Purpose Setting
1 NON STOP Non stop Used to set enable/disable of the FAX mode key when
Function
Note: Executable only with SRU (AR models). FAX is not installed. (When FAX is installed, the FAX
(Purpose)
mode is enabled regardless of this setup.)
Item Operation
26-50 Operation/procedure
Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
Purpose Setting
Default
Function Used to set ON/OFF of the black and white reversion
Item Content U.S.A, Canada,
(Purpose) function. Others
U.K., Australia
Item Operation
Effective (The message with
0 ON
Operation/procedure FAX uninstalled is displayed.) 0 1
Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key. 1 OFF Disable (Error Beep)
Item Content Default This setup varies in connection with SIM 26-6 (Destination setup).
0 ON Enable 1 (U.K.)
1 OFF Disable 0 (Others)
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 20
26-69
27
Purpose Setting
Function (Purpose) Toner near end setting
27-1
Item Operation
Purpose Setting
Operation/procedure
Function Used to set PC/MODEM communication trouble
Item Set value Default (Purpose) (U7-00) detection Yes/No.
1 Toner preparation 0: Displayed 0 Section Communication (RIC/MODEM)
message display 1: Not displayed Item Specifications Operation mode (Common)
setting.
Operation/procedure
2 Toner near end 0: Displayed 0
Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
massage display 1: Not displayed
setting. Item Content Default
3 Toner end status 1: Operate 3 In case of the communication trouble, U7-00 is
0 OFF
operation setting. 2: Operate (However, if not displayed.
CRUM ID matches, not 0
In case of the communication trouble, U7-00 is
operates.) 1 ON
displayed.
3: Not operate
4 E-mail alert sending 0: When the near near 1
timing setting. toner end, the toner low
27-2
status is sent.
1: When the near toner Purpose Setting
end, the toner low Senders registration number/HOST server
Function (Purpose)
status is sent. TEL number.
Operation/procedure
1. The current setting value is displayed in PRESENT field.
26-71
2. Enter the number with 10-key, the setting value is saved and the
Purpose Setting display of PRESENT is updated.
In the power save time setting, the pre-heat (pre-heat
mode setting) and the auto power shut off time can be 27-4
Function
set to the short time setup (pre-heat: 1 min, auto power
(Purpose) Purpose Setting
shut off: 4 min) and the long time setup (pre-heat:
5min, auto power shut off: 30min). Function (Purpose) Function setting
Operation/procedure Operation/procedure
Select the short time setup or the long time setup of the pre-heat time Enter the item number of setting with 10-key, press [START] key.
and the auto power shut off time with the 10-key, and press the Setting
Display Contents Default
[START] key. range
Item Content Default 1 RETRY Recall number setting when
0-5 2
BUSY busy (unit: times)
1 Preheat: 1min, auto power shut off: 4min
2 2 TIMER Recall interval setting when
2 Preheat: 5min, auto power shut off: 30min
(MINUTES) busy (unit:minute) 1-15 3
Note: When the sub code 71 is entered to display the setting menu,the BUSY
default values are always displayed. (However,the default time is 3 RETRY Recall number setting when
0-15 1
not always set.) ERROR send error (unit: times)
4 TIMER Recall interval setting when
26-72 (MINUTES) send error (unit: minute) 1-15 1
ERROR
Purpose Setting 5 TONER Toner order Empty 0
The letterhead support is set. ORDER auto send Near End 1
Function When Letterhead paper setting is selected, the set TIMING timing setting 25% or less 2
(Purpose) value of SIM 26-46 (Image output direction setting) is 0-5 3
25-49% 3
set to Setting Enable accordingly. 50-74% 4
Operation/procedure 75-100% 5
6 FAX INIT Retry number setting of initial
Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key. 0-15 2
RETRY connection (unit: times)
Setting
Item Content Default
range
0 OFF Letterhead paper is not set.
0-1 0
1 ON Letterhead paper is set.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 21
27-5 27-15
Purpose Setting Purpose Operation test/check
Function (Purpose) Used to set the tag number Function (Purpose) Displays status of FSS connection
Item Data Operation/procedure
Operation/procedure Enter the set value with the 10-key.
1. The currently set number is displayed on the PRESENT column. Item Content
2. Enter the new tag number (Max. 8 digits) with the 10-key. 0 OFF Not connected
The entered number is displayed on the NEW column. 1 ON Connected
3. Press the [START] key.
The set value is stored and PRESENT is revised.
27-7
30
Purpose Setting
30-1
Function (Purpose) FSS function setting
Purpose Operation test/check
Operation/procedure
Function Used to display the sensor status attached to the
Enter the item number of setting with 10-key, press [START] key. (Purpose) machine.
Item Set value Section Others
1 FUNCTION* 0: FSS function enable Item Operation
1: FSS function disable (*) (Default)
Operation/procedure
2 ALERT 0: Alert call enable (Default)
1: Alert call enable The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.
3 CONNECTION 0: FAX connect enable (Default) PPD1H PS paper detection 1 sensor
1: E-MAIL connect enable PPD1L PS paper detection 2 sensor
PPD2 Fusing paper sensor
(*) The FSS function setting can be changed only from Disable to
POD1 1st paper exit paper out sensor
Enable. (Cannot be changed from Enable to Disable.)
DVCH Developing cartridge detection sensor
DRST Drum intial detection sensor
27-9 DSWR1 Interlock switch (side door)
Purpose Setting SFTHP Shifter home position sensor
Function (Purpose) FSS function adjustment POD2 2nd paper exit paper out sensor
TOPF 2nd paper exit full detection sensor
Operation/procedure
DSWR0 2nd paper exit cover open/close detection sensor
Setting
Display Contents Default LOEMP 1st paper exit empty detection sensor
range
DUP2 Reverse path paper sensor
1 FEED TIME1 Sensor distance transport
POD3 Right paper exit sensor
time (main unit)
0-100 50 PTOPF Right paper exit full sensor
2 FEED TIME2 Sensor distance transport
time (RSPF)
3 JAM ALERT Continuous JAM alert
1-100 10 30-2
judgment
Purpose Operation test/check
Used to display the status of the sensors attached to
27-10 Function the standard tray and the manual feed tray. (Use SIM
(Purpose) 4-2 for the option trays.)
Purpose Setting The sensor of an uninstalled tray is not displayed.
Function (Purpose) Trouble precognition history clear Section Paper feed
Operation/procedure Item Operation
Target of history that is cleared Operation/procedure
Scan gain retry times history The active sensors and detectors are highlighted.
Sensor distance paper transport history (main unit/RSPF) PED1 1st tray paper empty sensor
LUD1 1st tray paper upper limit detection sensor
27-14 CD1 1st tray empty sensor
PED2 2nd tray paper empty sensor
Purpose Setting
LUD2 2nd tray paper upper limit detection sensor
Function (Purpose) FSS connection test setting
CD2 2nd tray empty sensor
Operation/procedure PFD2 2nd tray paper pass sensor
Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key. DSWR2 2nd tray right door detection sensor
MPED Manual tray paper empty detection
Item Content
MPLS1 Manual tray length detection 1
0 OFF FSS connection test disable
MPLS2 Manual tray length detection 2
1 ON FSS connection test enable
MPLD1 Manual feed paper length detection 1
MPLD2 Manual feed paper length detection 2
Width detection size of the manual feed tray (one of them is displayed.)
A4/A3, LT/WLT, B5/B4, INV/LTR, A5/A4R, B5R, POSTCARD, EXTRA,
8K/16K
(At detection, highlighted)
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 22
40 41
40-1 41-1
Purpose Operation test/check Purpose Operation test/check
Function Used to check the sensor of the machine manual feed Function Used to check the document size detection photo
(Purpose) tray. (Purpose) sensor.
Section Paper feed Section Others
Item Operation Item Operation
Operation/procedure Operation/procedure
The active sensors and detectors are highlighted. The operation status of the sensors and detectors in the original size
MPLS1 Manual tray length detection 1 detection section are displayed. The active sensors and detectors are
MPLS2 Manual tray length detection 2 highlighted.
MPLD1 Manual feed paper length detection 1 Original cover state
MPLD2 Manual feed paper length detection 2 OCSW Open: Highlighted display
Close: Normal display
Width detection size of the manual feed tray (one of them is displayed.) Original sensor status
A4/A3, LT/WLT, B5/B4, INV/LTR, A5/A4R, B5R, POSTCARD, EXTRA, PD1 to 5 Without original: Normal display
8K/16K With original: Highlighted display
For AB series, PD1 to 5 is displayed, for inch series, PD1 to 4.
40-2
Purpose Adjustment 41-2
Function Used to adjust the manual paper feed tray paper width
Purpose Adjustment
(Purpose) detector detection level.
Function Used to adjust the detection level of the document size
Section Paper feed
(Purpose) photo sensor.
Item Operation
Section Others
Operation/procedure Item Operation
The adjustment method is of the 4-point system. Set the guide to Max.
Operation/procedure
(A3/WLetter) position, A4R/Letter R position, A5R/Invoice R position,
and Min. position for adjustment. Place an A3 (or WLT) document on the document table, and press
[START] key with the OC cover open.
1) Set A3/W Letter and fit the guide, then press the [START] key.
The adjustment is performed and the result is displayed.
2) Set A4R/LetterR and fit the guide, then press the [START] key.
Original cover state
3) Set to A5R/INVOICE R and fit the guide, then press the [START] key.
OCSW Open: Highlighted display
4) Narrow the guide at minimum, press the [START] key. Close: Normal display
5) Set the paper detection width (+), and press the [START] key. 1 to 5 PD sensor detection level (Hexadecimal display)
6) Set the paper detection width (), and press the [START] key.
The value in [ ] shows the threshold value. (Hexadecimal display)
If FAILED is displayed in procedure 1), 2), 3), or 4), it is NG of adjust- For AB series, 1 to 5 is displayed, for inch series, 1 to 4.
ment. Repeat the adjustment.
During execution of the simulation, EXECUTING is displayed.
Yes MID-L ADJ.ON
Middle position adjustment L
No MID-L ADJ.OFF
Yes NID-S ADJ.ON 41-3
Middle position adjustment S
No MID-S ADJ.OFF Purpose Operation test/check
Used to check the light reception level and the
Function
detection level of the original size detection photo
40-3 (Purpose)
sensor.
Purpose Adjustment Section Others
Function The AD conversion value of manual feed width Item Operation
(Purpose) detection is displayed.
Operation/procedure
Section Paper feed
The detection output level of each sensor is displayed in real time.
Item Operation
Original cover state
Operation/procedure
OCSW Open: Highlighted display
The AD conversion value of manual feed width detection is displayed. Close: Normal display
1 to 5 PD sensor detection level (Hexadecimal display)
The value in [ ] shows the threshold value of 20 degree detection
adjustment. (Hexadecimal display)
For AB series, 1 to 5 is displayed, for inch series, 1 to 4.
41-4
Purpose Adjustment
Function
Used to adjust the detection level of OC 20 degrees.
(Purpose)
Section Others
Item Operation
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 23
Operation/procedure Default
Set the OC cover at 20 degrees detection and press the [START] key. Setting (North
Item Content
The detection output level of each sensor is displayed in real time. range America (Europe)
Original cover state /Others)
OCSW Open: Highlighted display WarmUp Warmup
Close: Normal display Temp Sub complete
12 0 - 40 15
1 to 5 PD sensor detection level (Hexadecimal display) (122) temperature Sub
(122mm/s)
The value in [ ] shows the threshold value of 20 degree detection
600dpi 600dpi Main 150 -
adjustment. (Hexadecimal display) 13 190 195
Main (145) (145mm/s) 220
For AB series, 1 to 5 is displayed, for inch series, 1 to 4. 600dpi Sub 600dpi Sub 150 -
During execution, [EXECUTING] is highlighted. 14 190 195
(145) (145mm/s) 220
POST Postcard Main
150 -
15 CARD (145mm/s) 200
220
43 Main (145)
POST Postcard Sub
150 -
16 CARD Sub (145mm/s) 200
43-1 220
(145)
Purpose Setting CARDBOA Thick paper Main
150 -
Function 17 RD Main (145mm/s) 200
Used to set the fusing temperature. 220
(Purpose) (145)
Section Fixing (Fusing) CARDBOA Thick paper Sub
150 -
Item Operation 18 RD Sub (145mm/s) 200
220
(145)
Operation/procedure
600dpi 600dpi Main 150 -
1. Touch the item to be set. 19 175 185
Main (122) (122mm/s) 220
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
600dpi Sub 600dpi Sub 150 -
Default 20 175 185
(122) (122mm/s) 220
Setting (North CARDBOA Postcard Main
Item Content 150 -
range America (Europe) 21 RD Main (122mm/s) 190
/Others) 220
(122)
Ready Ready POST Postcard Sub
150 - 150 -
1 Temp Main temperature Main 185 190 22 CARD Sub (122mm/s) 190
220 220
(145) (145mm/s) (122)
Ready Ready POST Thick paper Main
150 - 150 -
2 Temp Sub temperature Sub 180 185 23 CARD (122mm/s) 190
220 220
(145) (145mm/s) (122mm/s)
Ready Ready CARDBOA Thick paper Sub
150 - 150 -
3 Temp Main temperature Main 175 180 24 RD Sub (122mm/s) 190
220 220
(122) (122mm/s) (122)
Ready Ready
150 -
4 Temp Sub temperature Sub 170 175
220
(122) (122mm/s) 43-10
WarmUp Warmup target
150 - Purpose Setting
5 Target Main temperature Main 180 190
220 Function Used to set the paper feed cycle timing when printing
(145) (145mm/s)
(Purpose) postcards.
WarmUp Warmup target
150 - Section Paper feed
6 Target Sub temperature Sub 180 190
220 Item Operation
(145) (145mm/s)
WarmUp Warmup target Operation/procedure
150 -
7 Target Main temperature Main 175 Input the set value with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
220
(122) (122mm/s) Setting range 1-99
WarmUp Warmup target Default 50
150 -
8 Target Sub temperature Sub 170
220
(122) (122mm/s)
WarmUp Warmup
9
Temp Main
(145)
complete
temperature Main
0 - 40 10 44
(145mm/s)
WarmUp Warmup 44-1
Temp Sub complete Purpose Setting
10 0 - 40 15
(145) temperature Sub Function Used to make various setups in each mode of process
(145mm/s) (Purpose) control.
WarmUp Warmup Image process
Temp Main complete Section
11 0 - 40 10 (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
(122) temperature Main Item Operation
(122mm/s)
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 24
Operation/procedure 44-14
Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
Adjustment/Setup/Operation data output/Check
Item Content Default Purpose
(Display/Print)
ENVIRONMENT Environmental correction Allow/ Function Used to display the environment (temperature,
1 1
ADJ. Inhibit (0: Inhibit, 1: Allow) (Purpose) humidity) correction information.
Duplex print correction Allow/
2 DUPLEX PRINT ADJ. 0 Item Operation
Inhibit (0: Inhibit, 1: Allow)
Transfer current enviroment Operation/procedure
ENVIROMENT ADJ
3 correction Allow/Innibit 0 The following data are displayed.
(TC)
(0: Inhibit, 1: Allow)
TH AREA Current environment area
TMP DATA Detection temperature of sensor (C)
44-2 HUD DATA Detection humidity of sensor (%)
Purpose Setting * The value before entry of SIM is displayed. (It is not revised in real
Function time.)
Drum life correction setting
(Purpose) If sim entry is just after power turned on, the display value is all 0.
Section Image process (Photoconductor)
Item Operation 44-16
Operation/procedure Purpose Setting
1. Select an item with 10-key, and press [START] key. Function
2. Enter the setting value, and press [START] key. Used to set the toner density control correction value.
(Purpose)
Item Content Default Image process
Section
Drum life correction Disable/ (Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
GRIDBIAS
1 Enable 1 Item Operation
ADJUST
(0: Disable, 1: Enable)
Operation/procedure
Sets the toner density control correction value of the traveling distance
count.
44-3
Setting
Purpose Setting Item Default
range
Function 1 0 - 93000 (31-sheet model) 1-99 50
Used to set the DV count correction.
(Purpose) 2 93001 - 186000 (31-sheet model) 1-99 50
Image process 3 186001 - 279000 (31-sheet model) 1-99 50
Section
(Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning) 4 279001 - 372000 (31-sheet model) 1-99 45
Item Operation 5 372001 - 465000 (31-sheet model) 1-99 45
6 465001 - 857313 (31-sheet model) 1-99 45
Operation/procedure
7 857314 - 1714625 (31-sheet model) 1-99 45
1. Select an item with 10-key, and press [START] key.
8 1714626 - 2571938 (31-sheet model) 1-99 45
2. Enter the setting value, and press [START] key. 9 2571939 - 3429250 (31-sheet model) 1-99 45
Item Content Default 10 3429251 - 4286563 (31-sheet model) 1-99 45
DV count correction Disable/ 11 4286564 - 5143875 (31-sheet model) 1-99 45
1 PR_LIFE_ADJUST Enable 1 12 5143876 - 6001188 (31-sheet model) 1-99 45
(0: Disable, 1: Enable) 13 6001189 - 6858500 (31-sheet model) 1-99 45
Life of toner control DV 14 6858501 - 7715813 (31-sheet model) 1-99 45
2 TN_LIFE_ADJUST correction Disable/Enable 1
15 7715814 - 8573125 (31-sheet model) 1-99 45
(0: Disable, 1: Enable)
16 8573126 - 9430438 (31-sheet model) 1-99 45
Printing rate correction
17 9430439 - 10287750 (31-sheet model) 1-99 45
3 RATE_ADJUST Disable/Enable 1
18 10287751 - 11145063 (31-sheet model) 1-99 45
(0: Disable, 1: Enable)
19 11145064 - 12002375 (31-sheet model) 1-99 45
Toner unconditionally supply
4 TONER_ADJUST correction Disable/Enable 1 20 12002376 - (31-sheet model) 1-99 45
(0: Disable, 1: Enable) 21 0 - 93000 (26-sheet model) 1-99 50
22 93001 - 186000 (26-sheet model) 1-99 50
23 186001 - 279000 (26-sheet model) 1-99 50
44-9 24 279001 - 372000 (26-sheet model) 1-99 45
Adjustment/Setup/Operation data output/Check 25 372001 - 465000 (26-sheet model) 1-99 45
Purpose 26 465001 - 857313 (26-sheet model) 1-99 45
(Display/Print)
27 857314 - 1714625 (26-sheet model) 1-99 45
Function Used to display the process control correction
(Purpose) information. 28 1714626 - 2571938 (26-sheet model) 1-99 45
29 2571939 - 3429250 (26-sheet model) 1-99 45
Image process
Section 30 3429251 - 4286563 (26-sheet model) 1-99 45
(Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
31 4286564 - 5143875 (26-sheet model) 1-99 45
Item Operation
32 5143876 - 6001188 (26-sheet model) 1-99 45
Operation/procedure 33 6001189 - 6858500 (26-sheet model) 1-99 45
Used to display the process control correction information. 34 6858501 - 7715813 (26-sheet model) 1-99 45
35 7715814 - 8573125 (26-sheet model) 1-99 45
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 25
Setting Setting Default
Item Default Item Content
range range *1 *2
36 8573126 - 9430438 (26-sheet model) 1-99 45 145mm/s normal paper N1
6 +V1S-R (145) 5-30 5
37 9430439 - 10287750 (26-sheet model) 1-99 45 +V1 Duplex (Back)
145mm/s normal paper N1
38 10287751 - 11145063 (26-sheet model) 1-99 45
7 +V2S-F (145) +V2 single surface. Duplex 5-30 22
39 11145064 - 12002375 (26-sheet model) 1-99 45
(Front)
40 12002376 - (26-sheet model) 1-99 45
145mm/s normal paper N1
8 +V2S-R (145) 5-30 18
+V2 Duplex (Back)
145mm/s normal paper N2
44-17
9 +V1SS-F (145) +V1 single surface. Duplex 5-30 5
Adjustment/Setup/Operation data output/Check (Front)
Purpose
(Display/Print) 145mm/s normal paper N2
10 +V1SS-R (145) 5-30 5
Function Used to display the toner density control reference +V1 Duplex (Back)
(Purpose) value. 145mm/s normal paper N2
Image process 11 +V1SS-F (145) +V2 single surface. Duplex 5-30 5
Section (Front)
(Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
Item Operation 145mm/s normal paper N2
12 +V1SS-R (145) 5-30 5
+V2 Duplex (Back)
Operation/procedure 145mm/s thick paper > LTR
The following data are displayed. (The displayed value is the previous 13 +V1 THICK (145) 5-30 5
+V1
print correction value.) 145mm/s thick paper > LTR
14 +V2 THICK (145) 5-30 14
TARGET Toner concentration control reference value +V2
DEV REF Developer adjustment value +V1 THICK S 145mm/s thick paper t LTR
15 5-30 5
LIFE Toner container life correction value (SIM 44-16) (145) +V1
+V2 THICK S 145mm/s thick paper t LTR
TH Toner container environment correction value 16 5-30 18
(145) +V2
TARGET = DEV REF+(LIFE-50)+(TH-50) 145mm/s thin paper > LTR
17 +V1 THIN (145) 5-30 5
Developer adjustment value 128, life correction 60 (developer adjust- +V1
ment value plus 10), environment correction 45 (5 subtraction correc- 145mm/s thin paper > LTR
18 +V2 THIN (145) 5-30 18
tion), rapid toner supply correction = 128+(60-50)+(45-50) = 133.) +V2
145mm/s thin paper t LTR
19 +V1 THIN S (145) 5-30 5
+V1
44-34
145mm/s thin paper t LTR
20 +V2 THIN S (145) 5-30 18
Purpose Setting +V2
Function 145mm/s label paper > LTR
Used to set the transfer current value in each mode. 21 +V1 LABEL (145) 5-30 5
(Purpose) +V1
145mm/s label paper > LTR
Operation/procedure 22 +V2 LABEL (145) 5-30 18
+V2
1. Touch the item to be set. +V1 LABEL S 145mm/s label paper t LTR
23 5-30 5
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key. (145) +V1
To support an individual necessity in paper and the environment, it is +V2 LABEL S 145mm/s label paper t LTR
24 5-30 18
variable in the range of 5 to 30uA in the increment of 1uA in each mode. (145) +V2
25 +V1 OHP (145) 145mm/s OHP > LTR +V1 5-30 5
When changing +V2, check with +V1 unchanged. If there is any trouble
26 +V2 OHP(145) 145mm/s OHP > LTR +V2 5-30 14
in the half tone image of graphics, keep the relationship between +V1
27 +V1 OHP S (145) 145mm/s OHP t LTR +V1 5-30 5
and +V2 at the default and change it.
28 +V2 OHP S (145) 145mm/s OHP t LTR +V2 5-30 18
When the image quality is deteriorated because the user selects the +V1 POSTCARD 145mm/s postcard/envelope
OHP mode and use other than the recommended OHP, decrease the 29 5-30 5
(145) > 100mm +V1
transfer current to adjust deterioration of black background picture qual- +V2 POSTCARD 145mm/s postcard/envelope
ity. If some of characters are not printed, increase the transfer current. 30 5-30 26
(145) > 100mm +V2
This setting is changed in linkage with SIM 26-6 destination setting. +V1 POSTCARD 145mm/s postcard/envelope
31 5-30 5
*1: SECL/SCA/SEF/EX inch series/EX AB series/EX inch series (FC)/ S (145) t 100mm +V1
EX AB series (FC)/China/Taiwan/SEEG2 +V2 POSTCARD 145mm/s postcard/envelope
32 5-30 26
*2: SEC/SEEG/SUK S (145) t 100mm +V2
122mm/s normal paper W
Setting Default
Item Content 33 +V1F (122) +V1 single surface. Duplex 5-30 5
range *1 *2
(Front)
145mm/s normal paper W
122mm/s normal paper W
1 +V1F (145) +V1 single surface. Duplex 5-30 5 34 +V1R (122) 5-30 5
+V1 Duplex (Back)
(Front)
122mm/s normal paper W
145mm/s normal paper W
2 +V1R (145) 5-30 5 35 +V2F (122) +V2 single surface. Duplex 5-30 12 14
+V1 Duplex (Back)
(Front)
145mm/s normal paper W
122mm/s normal paper W
3 +V2F (145) +V2 single surface. Duplex 5-30 18 20 36 +V2R (122) 5-30 10
+V2 Duplex (Back)
(Front)
122mm/s normal paper N1
145mm/s normal paper W
4 +V2R (145) 5-30 14 18 37 +V1S-F (122) +V1 single surface. Duplex 5-30 5
+V2 Duplex (Back)
(Front)
145mm/s normal paper N1
122mm/s normal paper N1
5 +V1S-F (145) +V1 single surface. Duplex 5-30 5 38 +V1S-R (122) 5-30 5
+V1 Duplex (Back)
(Front)
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 26
Setting Default
Item Content
range *1 *2
46
122mm/s normal paper N1
39 +V2S-F (122) +V2 single surface. Duplex 5-30 14 46-2
(Front)
Purpose Adjustment
122mm/s normal paper N1
40 +V2S-R (122) 5-30 12 Function
+V2 Duplex (Back) Used to set the exposure level in each exposure mode.
122mm/s normal paper N2 (Purpose)
41 +V1SS-F (122) 5-30 5 Item Picture quality Density
+V2 Duplex (Back)
122mm/s normal paper N2 Operation/procedure
42 +V1SS-R (122) +V1 single surface. Duplex 5-30 5 1. Touch the item to be adjusted. (Automatic adjustment)
(Front) The currently set value is highlighted beside the adjustment item.
122mm/s normal paper N2
43 +V2SS-F (122) 5-30 14 2. Press the [START] key.
+V1 Duplex (Back)
The display is shifted to the copy menu.
122mm/s normal paper N2
44 +V2SS-R (122) +V2 single surface. Duplex 5-30 12 3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
(Front) Use the 10-key to set the exposure level.
122mm/s thick paper > LTR 4. Press the [START] key.
45 +V1 THICK (122) 5-30 5
+V1 Copying is started.
122mm/s thick paper > LTR (Exposure mode)
46 +V2 THICK (122) 5-30 10
+V2
Setting
+V1 THICK S 122mm/s thick paper t LTR Item Content Default
47 5-30 5 range
(122) +V1
1 AE AE
+V2 THICK S 122mm/s thick paper t LTR
48 5-30 12 2 TEXT Character Level 3.0
(122) +V2
122mm/s thin paper > LTR 3 TEXT/PHOTO Character/Photo Level 3.0
49 +V1 THIN (122) 5-30 5 4 PHOTO Photo Level 3.0 1-99 50
+V1
122mm/s thin paper > LTR 5 AE(TS) AE (TS)
50 +V2 THIN (122) 5-30 12
+V2 6 TEXT(TS) Character (TS) Level 3.0
122mm/s thin paper t LTR 7 TEXT/PHOTO(TS) Character/Photo (TS) Level 3.0
51 +V1 THIN S (122) 5-30 5
+V1
122mm/s thin paper t LTR * Except for AE and AE (TS), only Level 3 can be set.
52 +V2 THIN S (122) 5-30 12 Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display returns to the initial
+V2
122mm/s label paper > LTR menu but the machine is not reset.
53 +V1 LABEL (122) 5-30 5
+V1
122mm/s label paper > LTR
54 +V2 LABEL (122) 5-30 12
+V2 46-9
+V1 LABEL S 122mm/s label paper t LTR
55 5-30 5 Purpose Adjustment
(122) +V1
Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination
+V2 LABEL S 122mm/s label paper t LTR Function
56 5-30 12 value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode
(122) +V2 (Purpose)
57 +V1 OHP (122) 122mm/s OHP > LTR +V1 5-30 5 (Text).
58 +V2 OHP (122) 122mm/s OHP > LTR +V2 5-30 8 Item Picture quality Density
59 +V1 OHP S (122) 122mm/s OHP t LTR +V1 5-30 5 Operation/procedure
60 +V2 OHP S (122) 122mm/s OHP t LTR +V2 5-30 12 1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
+V1 POSTCARD 122mm/s postcard/envelope The adjustment item and the currently set value are highlighted.
61 5-30 5
(122) > 100mm +V1
2. Press the [START] key.
+V2 POSTCARD 122mm/s postcard/envelope
62 5-30 16 The display is shifted to the copy menu.
(122) > 100mm +V2
+V1 POSTCARD 122mm/s postcard/envelope 3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
63 5-30 5 Use the 10-key to set the exposure level.
S (122) t 100mm +V1
+V2 POSTCARD 122mm/s postcard/envelope 4. Press the [START] key.
64 5-30 16
S (122) t 100mm +V2 Copying is started.
(Exposure mode (Text))
Setting
Item Content Default
44-40 range
1 1.0 (SHIFT) Character level 1.0 (shift qty) 1-99 22
Purpose Setting
2 1.0 (GAMMA) Character level 1.0 (slant) 1-99 44
Used to set the time from the start of the main motor 3 2.0 (SHIFT) Character level 2.0 (shift qty) 1-99 36
Function
rotation (Ready) to the start of toner supply in previous 4 2.0 (GAMMA) Character level 2.0 (slant) 1-99 47
(Purpose)
rotation after turning on the power.
5 3.0 (SHIFT) Character level 3.0 (shift qty) 1-99 50
Operation/procedure 6 3.0 (GAMMA) Character level 3.0 (slant) 1-99 50
Enter the set value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key. 7 4.0 (SHIFT) Character level 4.0 (shift qty) 1-99 61
8 4.0 (GAMMA) Character level 4.0 (slant) 1-99 55
Set the toner supply previous rotation time.
9 5.0 (SHIFT) Character level 5.0 (shift qty) 1-99 72
Setting range 1-99 (sec) 10 5.0 (GAMMA) Character level 5.0 (slant) 1-99 60
Default 4 (sec) TS 1.0 Character (TS) level 1.0
11 1-99 22
(SHIFT) (shift qty)
1TS 1.0 Character (TS) level 1.0
12 1-99 44
(GAMMA) (slant)
TS 2.0 Character (TS) level 2.0
13 1-99 36
(SHIFT) (shift qty)
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 27
Setting Setting
Item Content Default Item Content Default
range range
TS 2.0 Character (TS) level 2.0 TS 3.0 Character/Photo (TS) level 3.0
14 1-99 47 16 1-99 50
(GAMMA) (slant) (GAMMA) (slant)
TS 3.0 Character (TS) level 3.0 TS 4.0 Character/Photo (TS) level 4.0
15 1-99 50 17 1-99 57
(SHIFT) (shift qty) (SHIFT) (shift qty)
TS 3.0 Character (TS) level 3.0
16 1-99 50 TS 4.0 Character/Photo (TS) level 4.0
(GAMMA) (slant) 18 1-99 61
(GAMMA) (slant)
TS 4.0 Character (TS) level 4.0
17 1-99 61 TS 5.0 Character/Photo (TS) level 5.0
(SHIFT) (shift qty) 19 1-99 64
(SHIFT) (shift qty)
TS 4.0 Character (TS) level 4.0
18 1-99 55 TS 5.0 Character/Photo (TS) level 5.0
(GAMMA) (slant) 20 1-99 66
(GAMMA) (slant)
TS 5.0 Character (TS) level 5.0
19 1-99 72 Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display returns to the initial
(SHIFT) (shift qty)
TS 5.0 Character (TS) level 5.0 menu but the machine is not reset.
20 1-99 60
(GAMMA) (slant)
Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display returns to the initial 46-11
menu but the machine is not reset. Purpose Adjustment
Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination
Function
value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode
46-10 (Purpose)
(Photo).
Purpose Adjustment Item Picture quality Density
Used to adjust the shift amount and the inclination Operation/procedure
Function
value for each level (1 to 5) of the exposure mode
(Purpose) 1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
(Text/Photo).
The adjustment item and the currently set value are highlighted.
Item Picture quality
2. Press the [START] key.
Operation/procedure The display is shifted to the copy menu.
1. Touch the item to be adjusted. 3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
The adjustment item and the currently set value are highlighted. Use the 10-key to set the exposure level.
2. Press the [START] key. 4. Press the [START] key.
The display is shifted to the copy menu. Copying is started.
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density. (Exposure mode (Photo))
Use the 10-key to set the exposure level. Setting
Item Content Default
4. Press the [START] key. range
Copying is started. 1 1.0(SHIFT) Photo level 1.0 (shift qty) 16
(Exposure mode (Text/Photo)) 2 1.0(GAMMA) Photo level 1.0 (slant) 50
3 2.0(SHIFT) Photo level 2.0 (shift qty) 33
Setting
Item Content Default 4 2.0(GAMMA) Photo level 2.0 (slant) 50
range
5 3.0(SHIFT) Photo level 3.0 (shift qty) 50
Character/Photo level 1.0 1-99
1 1.0 (SHIFT) 1-99 30 6 3.0(GAMMA) Photo level 3.0 (slant) 50
(shift qty)
7 4.0(SHIFT) Photo level 4.0 (shift qty) 56
Character/Photo level 1.0
2 1.0 (GAMMA) 1-99 37 8 4.0(GAMMA) Photo level 4.0 (slant) 61
(slant)
9 5.0(SHIFT) Photo level 5.0 (shift qty) 62
Character/Photo level 2.0 10 5.0(GAMMA) Photo level 5.0 (slant) 66
3 2.0 (SHIFT) 1-99 40
(shift qty)
Character/Photo level 2.0 Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display returns to the initial
4 2.0 (GAMMA) 1-99 43 menu but the machine is not reset.
(slant)
Character/Photo level 3.0
5 3.0 (SHIFT) 1-99 50
(shift qty) 46-12
Character/Photo level 3.0 Purpose Adjustment
6 3.0 (GAMMA) 1-99 50
(slant)
Function FAX exposure level adjustment
Character/Photo level 4.0 (Purpose) (1 mode automatic adjustment)
7 4.0 (SHIFT) 1-99 57
(shift qty)
Section FAX
Character/Photo level 4.0
8 4.0 (GAMMA) 1-99 61 Item Image quality
(slant)
Character/Photo level 5.0 Operation/procedure
9 5.0 (SHIFT) 1-99 64
(shift qty) 1. Select 1: COPY START.
Character/Photo level 5.0 The currently set value is displayed beside the item.
10 5.0 (GAMMA) 1-99 66
(slant) 2. Enter the set value of the exposure level with the 10-key, and press
TS 1.0 Character/Photo (TS) level 1.0 the [#/P] key.
11 1-99 30
(SHIFT) (shift qty) 3. Press the [START] key.
TS 1.0 Character/Photo (TS) level 1.0 Copying is started and the set value is stored.
12 1-99 37
(GAMMA) (slant) Normal display NOW PRINTING
TS 2.0 Character/Photo (TS) level 2.0 DOOR OPEN
13 1-99 40
(SHIFT) (shift qty) Error display JAM
TS 2.0 Character/Photo (TS) level 2.0 PAPER EMPTY
14 1-99 43
(GAMMA) (slant)
TS 3.0 Character/Photo (TS) level 3.0
15 1-99 50
(SHIFT) (shift qty)
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 28
There is no tray selection operation. 46-15
The optimum paper tray for the scanned size is selected.
Purpose Adjustment
Item Setting range Default
Function FAX exposure level adjustment
1 COPY START
2 FAX EXP.LEVEL 0-99 50 (Purpose) (Super Fine mode individual adjustment)
Section FAX
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed. Item Image quality
Operation/procedure
46-13 1. Select 1: COPY START.
The currently set value is displayed beside the item.
Purpose Adjustment
2. Enter the set value of the exposure level with the 10-key, and press
Function FAX exposure level adjustment
the [#/P] key.
(Purpose) (Normal mode individual adjustment)
Section FAX 3. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started and the set value is stored.
Item Image quality
Normal display NOW PRINTING
Operation/procedure
DOOR OPEN
1. Select 1: COPY START.
Error display JAM
The currently set value is displayed beside the item.
PAPER EMPTY
2. Enter the set value of the exposure level with the 10-key, and press
the [#/P] key. There is no tray selection operation.
3. Press the [START] key. The optimum paper tray for the scanned size is selected.
Copying is started and the set value is stored. Setting
Item Content Default
Normal display NOW PRINTING range
DOOR OPEN 1 COPY START Copy start
Error display JAM 2 EXP.LEVEL Exposure level selection
PAPER EMPTY Super Fine AE
3 AE (PHOTO ON)
There is no tray selection operation. (Half tone)
The optimum paper tray for the scanned size is selected. 4 AE (PHOTO OFF) Super Fine AE
0-99 50
MANUAL Super Fine MANUAL
Item Content Setting range Default 5
(PHOTO ON) (Half tone)
1 COPY START Copy start
2 EXP.LEVEL Exposure level selection MANUAL
6 Super Fine MANUAL
3 AE Normal text AE 0-99 50 (PHOTO OFF)
4 MANUAL Normal text MANUAL Note:Executable only when the FAX is installed.
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
46-16
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 29
46-18 46-20
Purpose Adjustment Purpose Adjustment
Function Function Used to set the exposure correction value of SPF/
Used to adjust inclination for each exposure mode.
(Purpose) (Purpose) RSPF for OC exposure.
Item Picture quality Item Picture quality
Operation/procedure Operation/procedure
1. Touch the item to be adjusted. 1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
The adjustment item and the current set value are highlighted. The adjustment item and the currently set value are highlighted.
2. Press the [START] key. 2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
The display is shifted to the copy menu. Item Content Setting range Default
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density. 1 SPF EXPOSURE SPF
1-99 53
Set the exposure level with the 10-key. 2 RSPF EXPOSURE RSPF
4. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started.
46-30
(Auto adjustment)
Setting Purpose Setting
Item Content Default
range Function Used to set the AE and the limit value in AE
1 AE AE (Purpose) (Toner save).
2 TEXT Character Level 3.0 Operation/procedure
3 TEXT/PHOTO Character/Photo Level 3.0
1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
4 PHOTO Photo Level 3.0
1-99 50 The adjustment item and the currently set value are highlighted.
5 AE(TS) AE(TS)
6 TEXT(TS) Character (TS) Level 3.0 2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
Character/Photo If SIM 26-6 (Destination setup) and SIM46-19 (Auto exposure mode)
7 TEXT/PHOTO(TS) Level 3.0
(TS) are changed, this setup is also changed to the default value accord-
ingly.
Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display returns to the initial
menu but the machine is not reset. Item Setting range Default
1 AE
0-31 0
2 AE(TS)
46-19
Purpose Adjustment
Function 46-31
Used to set the control method of the exposure mode.
(Purpose)
Purpose Setting
Item Picture quality
Function Used to set the AE and the limit value in AE
Operation/procedure (Purpose) (Toner save).
1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
Operation/procedure
The currently set value is highlighted beside the adjustment item.
1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
2. Press the [START] key.
The adjustment item and the currently set value are highlighted.
The display is shifted to the adjustment value entry menu.
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
3. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
Item Setting range Default
When the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key is pressed, the display returns to
1 AE
the original state (adjustment item selection menu).
2 TEXT
Item Content Default 0-2 1
3 TEXT/PHOTO
AE MODE Auto exposure mode*
1 (1:EXPOSURE (1: Priority on Image quality, 2 4 PHOTO
2:TONER) 2: Priority on toner consumption)
AE STOP(COPY) Auto exposure STOP mode
2 (0:FIXED (COPY) 0 46-39
1:REAL TIME) (0: Fixed, 1: Real-time)
Purpose Setting
AE STOP(FAX)
Auto exposure STOP mode (FAX) Function
3 (0:FIXED 0 Used to switch the FAX send image quality.
(0: Fixed, 1: Real-time) (Purpose)
1:REAL TIME)
AE STOP(SCAN) Auto exposure STOP mode Enter the set value with the 10-key.
4 (0:FIXED (SCANNER) 0 Item Content Setting range Default
1:REAL TIME) (0: Fixed, 1: Real-time) Original with pencil lines
Photo mode 0 HAIRLINE
5 PHOTO MODE 2 and thin lines 0-1 0
(1: ED (Error diffusion) , 2: DT (Dither)) 1 PRINTER Printed original
* Auto exposure mode
When SIM 26-6 (Destination setup) is changed from EX Japan to
Japan, the setup value becomes 1 (Default: Japan). If, on the con-
trary, it is changed from Japan to EX Japan, the set value becomes 2
(Default: EX Japan)
If the auto exposure mode setup value is changed, the setup value of
SIM 46-30 (AE limit setup) is reset to the default value.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 30
48-3
48
Purpose Adjustment
Function Used to adjust the print mode magnification ratio
48-1
(Purpose) correction.
Purpose Adjustment Section Image processing
Function Used to adjust the copy mode magnification ratio Item Picture quality
(Purpose) (main scanning direction, sub scanning direction).
Operation/procedure
Section Image processing
1. The adjustment item and the currently set value are highlighted.
Item Picture quality
2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key.
Operation/procedure
Changes magnification ratio by changing speed of main motor.
1. Touch the item to be set.
The change of the paper transfer speed is 0.1% when changing value
The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
is 1.
2. Press the [START] key.
The display is shifted to the copy menu. Setting
Item Content Default
range
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density, and enter the
1 145mm/s Main motor speed (145mm/s)
adjustment value with the 10-key. 45-55 50
2 122mm/s Main motor speed (122mm/s)
4. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started.
Setting 48-8
Item Content Default
range
Main scanning magnification Purpose Adjustment
1 F-R 50 Function
ratio adjustment FAX magnification adjustment (read)
Sub scanning magnification (Purpose)
2 SCAN 60 Section FAX
ratio adjustment
RSPF surface sub scan Related soft SW SW112-1 to 8, SW113-1 to 8
3 SPF (SIDE1) 1-99
magnification ratio Operation/procedure
RSPF back surface sub scan 1. Select 1: COPY START.
4 SPF (SIDE2) 50
magnification ratio The currently set value is highlighted beside the item.
DUPLEX sub scanning 2. Enter the set value of magnification with the 10-key, and press the
5 DUPLEX
magnification ratio adjustment [#/P] key.
Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the ini- 3. Press the [START] key.
tial menu, but the machine is not reset. Copying is started and the set value is stored.
Normal display NOW PRINTING
48-2 DOOR OPEN
Error display JAM
Purpose Adjustment
PAPER EMPTY
Function Used to adjust the scanner mode magnification ratio
(Purpose) (main/sub scanning direction). There is no operation of tray selection.
Section Image processing The optimum paper tray for the scanned size is selected.
Item Picture quality Even when the SPF/RSPF is selected, if there is no original on the
Operation/procedure SPF/RSPF, the OC is scanned.
1. Touch the item to be set. Even when the OC is selected, if there is any original on the SPF/
The item and the currently set value are highlighted. RSPF, the SPF/RSPF is scanned. (Setting 2)
2. Press the [START] key.
The display is shifted to the copy menu. Setting
Item Content Default
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density, and enter the range
adjustment value with the 10-key. 1 COPY START Copy start
SCAN SELECT Scan selection
4. Press the [START] key. 2 1-255* 128
(OC/SPF/RSPF) (OC/ SPF/RSPF)
Copying is started.
SCAN Main scanning
Setting 3 OC(MAIN) magnification ratio 1-255* 128
Item Content Default
range adjustment (OC)
Main scanning magnification SCAN Sub scanning
1 F-R
ratio adjustment 4 OC(SUB) magnification ratio 1-255* 128
Sub scanning magnification adjustment (OC)
2 SCAN
ratio adjustment SCAN Main scanning
1-99 50
RSPF surface sub scan 5 SPF(MAIN) magnification ratio 1-255* 128
3 SPF (SIDE1)
magnification ratio adjustment (SPF)
RSPF back surface sub scan SCAN Sub scanning
4 SPF (SIDE2)
magnification ratio 6 SPF(SUB) magnification ratio 1-255* 128
adjustment (SPF)
SCAN Main scanning
7 RSPF(MAIN) magnification ratio 1-255* 128
adjustment (RSPF)
SCAN Sub scanning
8 RSPF(SUB) magnification ratio 1-255* 128
adjustment (RSPF)
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 31
* The adjustment can be made in the range of 12.7% - +12.7% by (Adjustment procedure)
the increment of 0.1%. 1. Note down the adjustment value of SIM 50-5 (Items 1, 2, 3, 4), and
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed. change the value to 99.
2. Set SIM 50-1 (Items 2, 3, 4, 5) to 1. (By setting to 1, there is no void.)
48-9 3. Place a chart with a clear lead edge (or a ruler) on the OC docu-
ment table.
Purpose Adjustment
Function (Purpose) FAX magnification adjustment (print) 4. Use SIM 50-1 (Item 1) to execute test print. Check the print out and
Section FAX adjust so that the lead edge image is printed. (1 - 99: About
0.127mm/Step)
Operation/procedure 5. Reset the adjustment values of SIM 50-5 (Items 1, 2, 3, 4) to the
1. Select 1: COPY START. original values, and execute test print. Check the print out and
The currently set value is displayed beside the item. adjust so that the lead edge image is printed on the lead edge of
2. Press the [START] key. paper. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm/Step).
Copying is started and the set value is stored. 6. Adjust SIM 50-1 (Items 2, 3, 4, 5) so that the lead edge void on the
Normal display NOW PRINTING print out is the specified value. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
DOOR OPEN 7. Similar to procedure 6, adjust SIM 50-1 (Item 6, 7) so that the rear
Error display JAM edge void is the specified value. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
PAPER EMPTY 8. Similar to procedure 6, adjust SIM 50-1 (Item 8, 9) so that the left
edge void is the specified value. (1 - 99: About 0.127mm/Step)
There is no operation of tray selection.
9. Make an enlargement copy (400%), and check that there is no
The optimum paper tray for the scanned size is selected.
shade of the cabinet printed at the lead edge.
When two pages are scanned, duplex printing is made.
10. If there is a shade printed at the lead edge in procedure 9, adjust
Setting SIM 50-1 (Item 10). (1 - 5: About 0.677mm)
Item Content Default
range * If there is no problem, set to 2.
1 COPY START Copy start 1-255 128
Print magnification ratio Setting
2 Horizontal adjustment (Horizontal, vertical 1-255 128 Item Content Default
range
to paper passing) Original scan start position
Print magnification ratio adjustment
3 Vertical adjustment (Vertical, parallel to 1-255 128 1 RRC-A 1-99 43
Lead edge position
paper passing) adjustment value (OC)
Print magnification ratio Lead edge cancel
Horizontal adjustment on the back surface 2 DEN-A 1-99 18
4 1-255 128 adjustment (Main tray)
(DUPLEX) (Horizontal, vertical to paper Lead edge cancel
passing) 3 DEN-A-MANUAL adjustment (Manual feed 1-99 18
Print magnification ratio tray)
Vertical adjustment on the back surface Lead edge cancel
5 1-255 128 4 DEN-A -OPTION 1-99 18
(DUPLEX) (Vertical, parallel to paper adjustment (Option tray)
passing) Lead edge cancel
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed. 5 DEN-A -DUPLEX adjustment (back of the 1-99 18
machine)
6 DEN-B Rear edge void adjustment 1-99 30
Rear edge void adjustment
50 7 DEN-B-DUP
(Duplex)
1-99 50
Left edge void adjustment
8 SIDE VOID 1-99 18
50-1 (First print surface)
Left edge void adjustment
Purpose Adjustment 9 SIDE VOID-DUP 1-99 18
(Duplex)
Function Image loss amount
Used to adjust the copy lead edge position.
(Purpose) 10 LOSS(OC) adjustment (Lead edge 1-5 3
Item Picture quality Image position image loss set value) (OC)
Operation/procedure
1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
The item and the currently set value are highlighted. 50-5
2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key and press the [P] key., Purpose Adjustment
The display goes to the copy menu. Function Used to adjust the print image position (top margin) on
When the [START] key is pressed, the display goes to the copying (Purpose) the print paper in the print mode.
state and print is started. Item Picture quality Print area
(When the [P] key is pressed: Copy menu)
Operation/procedure
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
Enter the exposure level with the 10-key.
The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
4. Press the [START] key.
2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key and press the [P] key.,
Copying is started.
The display goes to the copy menu.
Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the ini- When the [START] key is pressed, the display goes to the copying
tial menu, but the machine is not reset. state and print is started.
(When the [P] key is pressed: Copy menu)
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 32
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density. 4. Select the scanning method.
Enter the exposure level with the 10-key. Even when the SPF/RSPF is selected, if there is no original on the
4. Press the [START] key. SPF/RSPF, the OC is scanned.
Copying is started. Even when the OC is selected, if there is any original on the SPF/
Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the ini- RSPF, the SPF/RSPF is scanned. (Setting 2)
tial menu, but the machine is not reset. Setting
Item Content Default
Item Content Setting range Default range
1 TRAY1 1st tray 0-99 1 COPY START Copy start
2 OPTION Option tray SCAN
53 Scan selection (1: OC,
3 MANUAL Manual feed 1-99 2 SELECT (OC/ 1-3 1
2: SPF, 3: RSPF back)
4 DUPLEX Back print SPF/RSPF)
Scan lead edge position
3 LEAD adjustment value of the 43-57 50
50-6 selected method in 2.
Purpose Adjustment Scan left edge position
4 LEFT adjustment value of the 43-57 50
Function Used to adjust the print image position (top margin) on
selected method in 2.
(Purpose) print paper in the copy mode. (RSPF)
Scan rear edge position
Item Picture quality Image position
5 REAR adjustment value of the 43-57 50
Operation/procedure selected method in 2.
1. Touch the item to be adjusted. Scan right edge position
The item and the currently set value are highlighted. 6 RIGHT adjustment value of the 43-57 50
2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key and press the [P] key., selected method in 2.
The display goes to the copy menu. Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
When the [START] key is pressed, the display goes to the copying
state and print is started.
50-9
(When the [P] key is pressed: Copy menu)
Purpose Adjustment
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
Enter the exposure level with the 10-key. Function (Purpose) FAX lead edge adjustment (print)
Section FAX
4. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started. Operation/procedure
Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the ini- 1. Select 1: COPY START.
tial menu, but the machine is not reset. The currently set value is highlighted beside the item.
2. Press the [START] key.
Setting
Item Content Default Copying is started.
range
Surface original scan start Normal display NOW PRINTING
1 SIDE1 1-99 50 DOOR OPEN
position adjustment
Back original scan start Error display JAM
2 SIDE2 1-99 50
position set PAPER EMPTY
Rear edge void adjustment
3 END EDGE 1-99 50 There is no tray selection operation.
(RSPF)
Surface image loss quantity The optimum paper tray for the scanned size is selected.
4 LOSS(SIDE1) 1-5 3
set When two pages are scanned, duplex print is made,
5 LOSS(SIDE2) Back image loss quantity set 1-5 3 Setting
Surface rear edge image Item Content Default
6 REARLOS(SIDE1) 1-5 3 range
loss quantity set 1 COPY START Copy start
Back rear edge image loss
7 REARLOS(SIDE2) 1-5 3 Print lead edge void
quantity set
2 LEAD adjustment value 43-57 53
(Front surface)
Print left edge void
50-8
3 LEFT adjustment value 43-57 53
The adjustments on the machine side must have been normally (Front surface)
completed. Print rear edge void
Purpose Adjustment 4 REAR adjustment value 43-57 53
Function (Purpose) FAX lead edge adjustment (read) (Front surface)
Section FAX Print lead edge void
LEAD
5 adjustment value 43-57 53
Operation/procedure (DUPLEX)
(Back surface)
1. Select 1: COPY START. Print left edge void
The currently set value is highlighted beside the item. 6 LEFT (DUPLEX) adjustment value 43-57 53
2. Enter the correction value with the 10-key, and press the [#/P] key. (Back surface)
3. Press the [START] key. Print rear edge void
REAR
Copying is started. 7 adjustment value 43-57 53
(DUPLEX)
Normal display NOW PRINTING (Back surface)
DOOR OPEN Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
Error display JAM
PAPER EMPTY
There is no tray selection operation.
The optimum paper tray for the scanned size is selected.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 33
50-10
51
Purpose Adjustment
Used to adjust the print image center position.
Function 51-1
(Adjustment can be made for each paper feed
(Purpose)
section.) Purpose Adjustment
Section Image processing (ICU) Function
Used to adjust the OPC drum separation pawl ON time.
Item Picture quality Image position (Purpose)
Image process
Operation/procedure Section
(Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
Item Operation
The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key and press the [P] key., Operation/procedure
The display goes to the copy menu. 1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
When the [START] key is pressed, the display goes to the copying The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
state and print is started. 2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key.
(When the [P] key is pressed: Copy menu) Item Setting range Default
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density. 1 145mm/s
1-99 50
Enter the exposure level with the 10-key. 2 122mm/s
4. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started.
51-2
Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the ini-
tial menu, but the machine is not reset. Purpose Adjustment
Item Content Setting range Default Used to adjust the contact pressure of paper onto the
1 BYPASS Manual paper feed resist roller in each section (copier paper feed section,
Function duplex paper feed section, RSPF paper feed section).
2 TRAY1 1st tray
(Purpose) (When the print image position varies greatly for the
3 TRAY2 2nd tray
1-99 50 paper or when a lot of paper jam troubles occur, the
4 TRAY3 3rd tray
adjustment is required.)
5 TRAY4 4th tray Section Paper transport (Discharge/Switchback/Transport)
6 DUPLEX Back print Item Operation
Operation/procedure
50-12 1. Touch the item to be adjusted.
Purpose Adjustment The item and the currently set value are highlighted.
Function Used to adjust the print image center position. 2. Press the [START] key.
(Purpose) (Adjustment can be made for each document mode.) The display is shifted to the copy menu.
Section Image processing 3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key.
Item Picture quality Image position
4. Press the [START] key.
Operation/procedure Copying is started.
1. Touch the item to be adjusted. Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the ini-
The item and the currently set value are highlighted. tial menu, but the machine is not reset.
2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key and press the [P] key., Item Content Setting range Default
The display goes to the copy menu. 1 BYPASS Manual feed 1-99 50
When the [START] key is pressed, the display goes to the copying
2 TRAY1 1st tray 1-99 50
state and print is started.
3 TRAY2 2nd tray 1-99 50
(When the [P] key is pressed: Copy menu) 4 TRAY3 3rd tray 1-99 50
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density. 5 TRAY4 4th tray 1-99 50
Enter the exposure level with the 10-key. 6 DUPLEX Back print 1-99 70
4. Press the [START] key. 7 SPF(SIDE1) RSPF front surface 1-99 50
Copying is started.
8 SPF(SIDE2) RSPF back surface 1-99 50
Note: When this simulation is canceled, the display is shifted to the ini-
tial menu, but the machine is not reset.
Item Content Setting range Default 51-8
1 OC OC document scan
Purpose Setting
RSPF document front
2 SPF(SIDE1) Function Used to set the OPC drum separation pawl operation
surface scan 1-99 50
(Purpose) inhibit. (ON/OFF)
RSPF document back
3 SPF(SIDE2) Image process
surface scan Section
(Photoconductor/Developing/Transfer/Cleaning)
Item Operation
Operation/procedure
Select the set value with the 10-key.
Item Content Setting range Default
0 ON Enable
0-1 0
1 OFF Disable
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 34
51-9 Item Content Setting range Default
1 MAX POSITION Max. width
Purpose Setting 2 POSITION 1 Adjustment point 1
Function Used to adjust the OPC drum separation voltage ON/ 0-999 0
3 POSITION 2 Adjustment point 2
(Purpose) OFF timing. 4 MIN POSITION Min. width
Section Process (OPC drum, developing, transfer, cleaning)
Item Operation
53-8
Operation/Procedure
1. Touch the item to be adjusted. Purpose Adjustment
The item and the currently set value are highlighted. Used to adjust the RSPF scan position of the mirror
2. Enter the set value with the 10-key. unit automatically. For the RSPF scan position
automatic adjustment, the mirror unit is shifted to
Setting Function
Item Content Default 11mm before the RSPF glass cover edge, and is
range (Purpose)
operated automatically to scan images by the unit of 1
Separation voltage ON timing step, detecting the position up to the glass cover
* Transfer V2ON reference automatically.
1 SHV ON 25-90 50
(Synchronized with the
adjustment value of 50.) Operation/Procedure
Separation voltage OFF timing With the RSPF or the OC cover open, put a black background chart on
* Transfer V2OFF reference the OC glass (the RSPF glass surface is included for the RSPF stan-
2 SHV OFF 50-90 75 dard model), and press the [START] key.
(Synchronized with the
adjustment value of 50.) If the adjustment is executed normally, the adjustment value is dis-
played and saved in the EEPROM. If an error occurs, ERR is dis-
played and the value is not saved in the EEPROM.
If the adjustment is not performed because of abnormality, --- is dis-
53 played.
During execution of the adjustment, the operation cannot be inter-
rupted.
53-6
Purpose Adjustment 53-9
Used to adjust the detection level of the RSPF width.
The adjustment method is the 4-point system. Set the Purpose Adjustment
Function Function
guide to Max. (A3/WLetter) position, A4R/Letter R RSPF read position adjustment
(Purpose) (Purpose)
position, A5R/Invoice R position, and Min. position for
adjustment. Operation/Procedure
Section RSPF Press [START] key.
Operation/Procedure Item Setting range Default
(Max. position setting) Read position adjustment 1-99 50
1. Set the guide to the maximum position, and press the [START] key.
Set WLetter and fit the guide, and press the [START] key.
2. Set A4R/Letter R and fit the guide, and press the [START] key. 53-10
3. Set A5R/Invoice R and fit the guide, and press the [START] key.
Purpose Adjustment
4. Set the guide to the minimum position, and press the [START] key.
Function
5. Set the paper recognition width (+), and press the [START] key. RSPF exp adjustment
(Purpose)
6. Set the paper recognition width (),and press the [START] key.
Operation/Procedure
If FAILED is displayed in the above procedure 1, 2, 3, or 4, repeat the
1. Press [START] key.
adjustment.
2. Enter the adjustment value with the 10-key.
(Middle position L/S setting)
Item Setting range Default
If the middle position adjustment is not required, press the [START] key
1 SPF EXPOSURE
without changing the guide position. 1-99 53
2 RSPF EXPOSURE
Middle position YES MID-L ADJ.ON
adjustment L NO MID-L ADJ.OFF
Middle position YES MID-S ADJ.ON
adjustment S NO MID-S ADJ.OFF
55
53-7
55-1
Purpose Adjustment
Function Used to enter the RSPF width detection adjustment Purpose Setting
(Purpose) value. Function
Used to set the soft switch.
Section RSPF (Purpose)
Section Operation
Operation/Procedure
1. Touch the item to be adjusted. Operation/Procedure
The item and the currently set value are highlighted. Used to enter the number of SW to be changed.
2. Enter the RSPF original tray size adjustment value (specified on The bit to be changed is specified by 10-key. (The current value is high-
the back of the RSPF) with the 10-key. lighted.)
When [START] key is pressed, the entered value is set.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 35
3. Select the paper feed tray and the print density.
61 4. Press the [START] key.
Copying is started.
61-1 During execution of the print test, the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key and
Purpose Operation test/check the [INTERRUPTION] key are invalid.
Used to check the LSU (polygon motor) operation. Setting
Function Item Content Default
Check speed can select 145mm/s or 122mm/s range
(Purpose)
individually. Self print is made in 2 by 4 mode
Section LSU (printing 2 lines and not printing
Item Operation 4 lines). Since scanning is not
2 BY 4
1 performed, when the original is
Operation/procedure MODE
set on the RSPF, this cannot be
Press the [START] key, and the LSU test is performed. performed. 1-2 1
Used to set the LSU to ON state and check that the sync signal * Duplex print cannot be made.
(HSYNC/) is outputted or not. Lattice print (1cm, 1dot width
After operation for 30 sec, the result is displayed. (Interruption cannot LATTICE WLT, A3 print (A3 main scan,
be made for 5 sec after starting the operation.) 2
PRINT WLT sub scan)) is performed.
* Duplex print can be made.
* If the IMC board is not installed, the key inputs cannot be made.
63
63-1
65
Adjustment/setting/operation data output/check
Purpose
(display/print)
Function Used to check the result of shading correction. 65-1
(Purpose) (The shading correction data are displayed.) Purpose Adjustment
Section Scanner (Exposure) Function Used to adjust the touch panel (LCD display section)
Item Operation (Purpose) detection position.
Operation/procedure Section Operation (Display, Operation)
Pressing the [START] key performs shading, and displays the result Operation/Procedure
(center pixel). Press the keys displayed on the LCD sequentially.
Adjust the touch panel coordinates.
63-7
When the point of + on the LCD is pressed, it turns gray. Press all the
Purpose Adjustment four points of +.
Used to adjust the RSPF white correction start pixel
Function position automatically.
(Purpose) This adjustment is performed after the lens unit is 65-2
replaced.
Adjustment/Setting/Operation data output check
Section Scanner Purpose
(Display, Print)
Item Operation
Function Used to check the touch panel (LCD display section)
Operation/procedure (Purpose) detection position adjustment result.
Lift the RSPF unit to the fully open position, and press the [START] key. Section Operation (Display, Operation)
[ ] indicates the order number of the pixel of the white sheet for RSPF Operation/Procedure
exposure correction in the RSPF position.
Check the touch panel coordinates.
If the adjustment is normally completed, COMPLETE is displayed
and data are written into the EEPROM. Press the keys displayed on the LCD sequentially.
In case of an abnormality, ERROR is displayed and no data is written When the touch panel is pressed, the X-coordinate and the Y-coordi-
into the EEPROM. nate (dot conversion values) are displayed.
The RSPF white correction start pixel = Displayed pixel position 34
If the simulation is executed with the RSPF unit closed, an error will
result. 65-5
Adjustment/Setting/Operation data output check
Purpose
(Display, Print)
64 Function
Used to check the key inputs of the operation panel.
(Purpose)
Section Operation (screen/operation)
64-1
Operation/procedure
Purpose Operation test/check
Check the key input of the operation panel.
Function Used to check the operation of the printer function Press the keys displayed on the LCD sequentially.
(Purpose) (auto print operation).
After completion of all key entries, COMPLETE is displayed.
Section Printer
Item Operation
Operation/procedure
1. Select the print item with the 10-key.
2. Press the [START] key.
The display is shifted to the copy menu.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 36
66-3
66
Purpose Operation test/check
Function (Purpose) FAX PWB memory check
66-1
Section FAX
Purpose Setting Item Operation
Function
Used to change and check the FAX-related soft SW. Operation/procedure
(Purpose)
Section FAX Press the [START] key.
Read/write can be checked for FAX PWB memory.
Operation/procedure
The check result is displayed separately for each memory.
1. Enter the soft SW number to be selected with the 10-key.
1. Memory to be checked
2. Check and change the setting content of the selected soft SW.
DRAM
3. Press the [START] key to save the set content.
SRAM
The FAX-related soft SW is displayed on the LCD, and changing can
be made by monitoring it. Program area SUM check only
Flash ROM
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed. Memory area
The memory size follows the
Option memory
automatically detected value.
66-2 PAGE
Purpose Adjustment MODEM
Function Used to clear the FAX-related soft SW.
2. Detailed procedure
(Purpose) (Except for the FAX adjustment values)
Section FAX 55H is written to all the addresses of each memory, and the
1 address data are read in sequence to check that they were
Operation/procedure properly written.
1. Enter the country code with the 10-key, and press the [START] key. AAH is written to all the addresses of each memory, and the
2. When 1: (YES) is selected, the soft SW corresponding to the 2 address data are read in sequence to check that they were
country code is cleared. When 2: (NO) is selected, the simulation properly written.
is canceled. 00H is written to all the addresses of each memory, and the
Country code 3 address data are read in sequence to check that they were
Japan : 00000000 properly written.
Perform checks 1 - 3 sequentially. If there is no abnormality, it is
U.S.A. : 10110101
4 OK. If there is any abnormality, NG is notified to the error
Australia : 00001001 address.
U.K. : 10110100 The check result is saved. New result is overwrited with each
5
France : 00111101 check.
Germany : 00000100 Interruption cannot be made during operation.
Sweden : 10100101 Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
New Zealand : 01111110
China : 00100110
66-4
Singapore : 10011100
Taiwan : 11111110 Purpose Operation test/check
India : 01010011 Function
Signal send mode (Signal send level: Max.)
(Purpose)
Malaysia : 01101100
Section FAX
Hong Kong : 01010000
Item Operation
Middle east : 11111101
SouthAfrica : 10011111 Operation/procedure
Spain : 10100000 Select the signal number with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
The signal is sent to the line and the machine speaker. (Sending the
Portugal : 10001011
signal is continued until the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key is pressed.)
Russia : 10111000
By entering the signal number and pressing the [START] key during
Denmark : 00110001 execution, the signal kind can be changed.
Norway : 10000010 Item Send signal
Switzerland : 10100110 1 NO SIGNAL Signal not sent
Italy : 01011001 2 33.6 V34 33.6 V34
Belgium : 00001111 3 31.2 V34 31.2 V34
Luxembourg : 01101001 4 28.8 V34 28.8 V34
Netherlands : 01111011 5 26.4 V34 26.4 V34
Finland : 00111100 6 24.0 V34 24.0 V34
7 21.6 V34 21.6 V34
The codes other than the above are accepted as Japan. 8 19.2 V34 19.2 V34
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed. 9 16.8 V34 16.8 V34
10 14.4 V34 14.4 V34
11 12.0 V34 12.0 V34
12 9.6 V34 9.6 V34
13 7.2 V34 7.2 V34
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 37
Item Send signal Signal number Send signal
14 4.8 V34 4.8 V34 16 14.4 V33 14.4 V33
15 2.4 V34 2.4 V34 17 12.0 V33 12.0 V33
16 14.4 V33 14.4 V33 18 14.4 V17 14.4 V17
17 12.0 V33 12.0 V33 19 12.0 V17 12.0 V17
18 14.4 V17 14.4 V17 20 9.6 V17 9.6 V17
19 12.0 V17 12.0 V17 21 7.2 V17 7.2 V17
20 9.6 V17 9.6 V17 22 9.6 V29 9.6 V29
21 7.2 V17 7.2 V17 23 7.2 V29 7.2 V29
22 9.6 V29 9.6 V29 24 4.8 V27t 4.8 V27t
23 7.2 V29 7.2 V29 25 2.4 V27t 2.4 V27t
24 4.8 V27t 4.8 V27t 26 0.3 FLG 7EH Flag signal
25 2.4 V27t 2.4 V27t 27 CED2100
26 0.3 FLG 7EH Flag signal 28 CNG1100
Tone signal
27 CED2100 29 0.3 V21
28 CNG1100 30 ANSam
Tone signal
29 0.3 V21 Pseudo-ringer sound
31 RINGER
30 ANSam ([ON HOOK] key ON)
Pseudo-ringer sound Voice message (no sound)
31 RINGER
([ON HOOK] key ON) Under the state where the ring back tone can be
32 No MSG
Voice message (no sound) sent to the line, keep the sound composition IC
Under the state where the ring back tone can be volume to 0.
32 No MSG
sent to the line, keep the sound composition IC Ring back tone (no sound)
volume to 0. 33 No RBT Under the state where the ring back tone can be
Ring back tone (no sound) sent to the line, keep the G/A volume to 0.
33 No RBT Under the state where the ring back tone can be Dial pulse (make)
sent to the line, keep the G/A volume to 0. 34 DP MAKE Maintain the make state with keeping the condition
Dial pulse (make) to be able to send to the dial pulse line.
34 DP MAKE Maintain the make state with keeping the condition Dial pulse (break)
to be able to send to the dial pulse line. 35 DP BRK Maintain the break state with keeping the condition
Dial pulse (break) to be able to send to the dial pulse line.
35 DP BRK Maintain the break state with keeping the condition Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
to be able to send to the dial pulse line.
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
66-6
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 38
66-10 66-13
Purpose Adjustment/Setting/Check Purpose Setting
Function (Purpose) Image data memory clear Function (Purpose) Used to register the dial numbers.
Section FAX Section FAX
Item Data Image data Item Operation
Operation/procedure Operation/procedure
Select 1: YES with the 10-key and press the [START] key. (When 2: Enter the number with the 10-key, [*] key, and [#] key.
NO is selected, the simulation is canceled.)
Press the [CLEAR] key to return to the initial state.
Used to clear all image data (including confidential reception data)
Press the [START] key to register the entered number.
stored in image memory of the FAX section.
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
The management table is also cleared (initialized) at the same time.
* lIf there is any print data, the power must be turned off after clearing.
66-14
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
Purpose Operation check/test
66-11 Function
Used to perform the dial test. (10 PPS send test)
(Purpose)
Purpose Operation test/check Section FAX
Function Used to send 300bps signals.
Item Operation
(Purpose) (Signal send level: Max.)
Section FAX Operation/Procedure
Item Operation 1. Select the item with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
Operation/procedure 2. Set the make time with the 10-key.
Select the signal number with the 10-key, and press the [START] key. The dial is sent with the set value + 26ms.
By setting the signal number, the specified signal is delivered to the The sending dial cannot be interrupted.
line at the speed of 300bps. (The signal is continuously sent until the Item Content Setting range
interruption command is provided by pressing the [SYSTEM SET- 0 EXECUTE Execution
TINGS] key.) 1 MAKE TIME Dial pulse make time setting 0-15
The signal send level can be selected from 0dB or the soft SW set value.
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
The signal send level is returned to the soft SW set value before execu-
tion of the mode after completion of the mode.
66-15
By entering the number and pressing the [START] key during execu-
tion, the signal kind can be changed. Purpose Operation check/test
Item Function
Used to perform the dial test. (20 PPS send test)
1 NO SIGNAL (Purpose)
2 11111 Section FAX
3 11110 Item Operation
4 00000
5 010101 Operation/Procedure
6 00001 1. Select the item with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed. 2. Set the make time with the 10-key.
The dial is sent with the set value + 26ms.
66-12 The sending dial cannot be interrupted.
Purpose Operation test/check Item Content Setting range
Function Used to send 300bps signals. 0 EXECUTE Execution
(Purpose) (Signal send level: Set by soft SW) 1 MAKE TIME Dial pulse make time setting 0-15
Section FAX
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
Item Operation
Operation/procedure
66-16
Select the signal number with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
By setting the signal number, the specified signal is delivered to the Purpose Operation check/test
line at the speed of 300bps. (The signal is continuously sent until the Function
Used to perform the dial test. (DTFM signal send test)
interruption command is provided by pressing the [SYSTEM SET- (Purpose)
TINGS] key.) Section FAX
The signal send level can be selected from 0dB or the soft SW set value. Item Operation
The signal send level is returned to the soft SW set value before execu- Operation/Procedure
tion of the mode after completion of the mode. 1. Select the item with the 10-key, and press the [START] key.
By entering the number and pressing the [START] key during execu- 2. Enter the set value with the 10-key.
tion, the signal kind can be changed.
The sending dial cannot be interrupted.
Item
1 NO SIGNAL Setting
2 11111 Item Content
range
3 11110
4 00000 0 EXECUTE Execution
5 010101 1 HIGH (SW) High group 0-15
6 00001 2 HIGH-LOW (SW) High group, Low group 0-15
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 39
3. Select the soft SW reflection. 66-21
Item Content
Purpose Check
1 NO STORE TO SW Not reflected.
Function (Purpose) FAX information print
2 STORE TO SW Reflected. (Shift SW value changed.)
Section FAX
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed. Item Data
Operation/procedure
66-17 1. Select the item to be printed.
Purpose Operation check/test 2. Press the [START] key.
Function Used to check the DTFM signal send operation. The information of the selected item is printed.
(Purpose) (Signal send level: Max.) Item Content
Section FAX 1 USER SW.LIST User setting list
Item Operation
2 SOFT SW.LIST Soft SW list
Operation/procedure System error list
Enter the DTFM signal (1 digit (1 to 9, 0, *, #)) and press the [START] key. 3 SYSTEM ERROR Used to print the system error log (error
number and time).
When the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key is pressed during execution, the
simulation is terminated. Protocol error list
Regardless of soft SW38-1 status, the
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
protocol monitor of the preceding
communication is printed. (Printing is
66-18 4 PROTOCOL
allowed at any time before starting the
Purpose Operation check/test next communication.) For this operation,
the protocol monitor of one
Function Used to check the DTFM signal send operation.
communication is always buffered.
(Purpose) (Signal send level: Set by soft SW.)
PARTIAL SRAM
Section FAX 5 Used to clear the SRAM.
CLEAR
Item Operation
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
Operation/Procedure
Enter the DTFM signal (1 digit (1 to 9, 0, *, #)) and press the [START] key.
When the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key is pressed during execution, the 66-22
simulation is terminated.
Purpose Setting
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
Function
Handset sound volume adjustment (Japan only)
(Purpose)
66-19
Section FAX
Purpose Back up Item Operation
Function Operation/procedure
Used to write the SRAM data to the Flash ROM.
(Purpose)
1. Select the sound volume to be set.
Section FAX
(MAX: Large, MIDDLE: Medium, MIN: Small)
Item Data
2. Press [START] key.
Operation/Procedure Selection of 1, 2, and 3 can be made even during execution of the sim-
Select 1: YES with the 10-key, and press the [START] key. The data ulation.
are backed up. (When 2: NO is selected, the simulation is canceled.) A sound is generated during execution of the simulation.
* The AR-FX5 data cannot be written into the AR-FX7. If it is exe- Note: Execution is possible only when FAX is installed.
cuted, data are initialized and deleted. In addition, the AR-FX7 data
cannot be used in the AR-FX5.
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed. 66-24
Purpose Data clear
66-20 Function
Used to clear the FAST storage data. (SEC only)
Purpose Back up (Purpose)
Function Section FAX
Used to write the Flash ROM data to the SRAM. Item Data Initializing
(Purpose)
Section FAX Operation/procedure
Item Data Select 1: YES with the 10-key and press the [START] key. The FAST
Operation/Procedure storage data are cleared. (When 2: NO is selected, the simulation is
canceled.)
Select 1: YES with the 10-key, and press the [START] key. The Flash
ROM data are read out and written into the SRAM. (When 2: NO is Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
selected, the simulation is canceled.)
* The AR-FX5 data cannot be written into the AR-FX7. If it is exe-
cuted, data are initialized and deleted. In addition, the AR-FX7 data
cannot be used in the AR-FX5.
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 40
66-30 Operation/procedure
The send/receive test is performed, and the time required for send/
Purpose Operation test/check
receive of the image data in the test is measured and displayed.
Function (Purpose) Used to set the TEL/LIU.
Communication
Section FAX : Memory send
means
Item Operation Setup on the user : Normal Character
Picture quality
side when executing : Lighter
Operation/procedure Density
communication : ON
When the relay state of the polarity reverse relay, the handset hook ECM
: OFF
switch, or the external telephone hook switch is changed, the content Sender information
of change is displayed regardless of the soft SW setup (real time). The From flag reception before sending of image
Send
display of change is kept until an interruption command is supplied by Measuring data until sending of RCP frame
pressing the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key. range From flag reception before reception of
Receive
image data until reception of RCP frame
Notification contents
Item Used to make communication not in a
Signal low Signal high
Mode when measuring simulation process but in the normal screen
HS2 ON OFF and measure the time.
HS1 ON OFF Enter the simulation for communication time
How to check the time
RHS ON OFF check and check the time.
EXHS ON OFF Measuring unit msec
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed. When there are two or more send/receive operations of image data in
one communication, only the time of the last send/receive data near
66-31 the end is measured.
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed.
Purpose Setting
Function (Purpose) Used to set the TEL/LIU.
66-37
Section FAX
Item Operation Purpose Adjustment/Setting/Check
Function (Purpose) Speaker sound volume adjustment
Operation/Procedure
Section FAX
1. Enter the set value. (Valid only 1 to 5)
2. The entered bit is alternatively switched between 0 and 1 and Operation/procedure
the target signal name is highlighted. The following test sound is delivered to the line and the speaker to
3. Press the [START] key to send the signal. adjust the sound kind and volume.
When the [CUSTUM SETTINGS] key is pressed, the output is terminated. The send level to the line is the set value of soft SW.
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed. The set values of the selected sound kind and volume are written to
each soft SW.
1. Sound kinds pattern
66-32 Sound kinds (Test sound) Sound volume set value
Purpose Operation test/check RINGER Call sound DEF. LAR. MED. SMA.
Line monitor sound (Test
Function (Purpose) Receive data check
LINE MONITO sound: communication DEF. LAR. MED. SMA.
Section FAX
signal sound)
Item Operation
On-hook (Test sound,
Operation/procedure ON HOOK communication signal DEF. LAR. MED. SMA.
The fixed data received from the line are checked and the result is displayed. sound)
SCAN FINISH Scan finish sound DEF. LAR. MED. SMA.
When data are coincident, OK is displayed. When not, NG is displayed.
Communication finish
Note: Executable only when the FAX is installed. TX/RX FINISH DEF. LAR. MED. SMA.
sound
66-33 DTMF DTFM send sound DEF. LAR. MED. SMA.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 41
66-52 3. Press the [CA] key to cancel the simulation and reset.
(Flash Device) (Processing state)
Purpose Operation test/check (Japan only)
PROGRAM RECEIVE
Section FAX
BOOTROM ERASE
Item Operation PS KANJI FONT WRITE
Function ESC/P KANJI FONT VERIFY
Pseudo-ringer check
(Purpose) OPTION FONT
Operation/procedure * Execution of the simulation which performs communication with the
Press [START] key. PCL board is inhibited until Notice Page storage is completed. (Only
The call sound of the machine and the pseudo-ring are generated. when the serviceman call error occurs.)
* In the other case than the serviceman call error, entering the simula-
67 tion is inhibited during the system check operation is displayed.
67-15
67-1
Purpose Operation test/check Purpose Operation test/check
Function Used to execute read/write check of the RAM on the Function Used to check the validity of the ROM on the PCL
(Purpose) PCL board, and to display the result. (Purpose) board and the result is displayed.
Section Printer Section Printer
Item Operation Item Operation
Operation/Procedure Operation/procedure
Press the [START] key. Press the [START] key.
Read/write check of the RAM on the PCL board is performed and the Each ROM on the PCL board is checked and the result is displayed.
result is displayed. The display of --- is changed to CHECKING, OK, or NG accord-
The presence of DIMM is detected. If there is no DIMM, --- is displayed. ing to the message number included in the continuation command.
If there is, read/write check is performed and the result is displayed. When the simulation is completed normally, COMPLETE is displayed.
The display of --- is changed to CHECKING, OK, or NG accord- (No display for abnormal completion.)
ing to the message number included in the continuation command. Since only the devices installed to the PCL board are checked when
When the simulation is completed normally, COMPLETE is displayed. the simulation is started, the display may not be changed from ---.
(No display for abnormal completion.) (No message is sent for an uninstalled device.)
Since only the devices installed to the PCL board are checked when Key operations on each display
the simulation is started, the display may not be changed from ---. (Initial display)
(No message is sent for an uninstalled device.)
Pressing the [INTERRUPT] key shifts the display to the previous menu.
Key operations on each display Pressing the [CA] key leads to resetting. The [C] key and the [CUS-
(Initial display) TOM SETTINGS] key are invalid. (Beep sound).
Pressing the [INTERRUPT] key shifts the display to the previous menu. (Execution display)
Pressing the [CA] key leads to resetting. Pressing the [C] key, and the During execution, the [INTERRUPT] key, the [C] key, and the [CA] key
[SYSTEM SETTINGS] key is invalid. (Beep sound) are invalid. (Beep sound). Pressing the [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key pro-
(Display during execution) duces a valid sound only.
During execution, the [INTERRUPT] key, [C] key, and the [CA] key are (Check end display)
invalid. (Beep sound). The [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key produces a valid After execution, the [INTERRUPT] key and the [C] key are invalid.
sound only. (Beep sound). Pressing the [CA] key leads to resetting. Pressing the
(Check end display) [SYSTEM SETTINGS] key produces a valid sound only.
After execution, the [INTERRUPT] key and the [C] key are invalid. After completion of the simulation, reset the machine.
(Beep sound). Pressing the [CA] key leads to resetting. The [SYSTEM
SETTINGS] key produces a valid sound only.
After completion of the simulation, reset the machine. 67-17
Purpose Data clear
67-14
Function Used to clear the printer section setting.
Purpose Flash ROM version up (Purpose) (NVRAM clear)
Function Operation/procedure
Used to check write/comparison of flash programs.
(Purpose)
1. Press the [START] key.
Section Printer The confirmation dialogue is displayed.
Item Operation
2. Select 1: YES with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
Operation/procedure 1: YES (Cleared)
1. Press the [START] key. 2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
PLEASE SEND DATA is displayed. If there is no abnormality after Clear operation, COMPLETE is dis-
2. Data are sent from the PC (MS-DOS) by use of fcopy command played. If there is any abnormality, ERROR is displayed.
(FCOPY: file name). (Refer the [7] FLASH ROM VERSION UP * Execution of the simulation which performs communication with the
PROCEDURE) PCL board is inhibited until Notice Page storage is completed. (Only
Used to overwrite and check the flash device while displaying its when the serviceman call error occurs.)
process status. * In the other case than the serviceman call error, entering the simula-
After completion, the result is displayed. tion is inhibited during the system check operation is displayed.
Note: Executable only when the PCL is installed.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 42
67-18
Purpose Data clear
Function Used to clear the data area for FLASH ROM Network
(Purpose) Scanner Application.
Operation/procedure
1. Press the [START] key.
The confirmation dialogue is displayed.
2. Select 1: YES with the 10-key and press the [START] key.
1: YES (Cleared)
2: NO (Not cleared) (Default)
If there is no abnormality after Clear operation, COMPLETE is dis-
played. If there is any abnormality, ERROR is displayed.
* Execution of the simulation which performs communication with the
PCL board is inhibited until Notice Page storage is completed. (Only
when the serviceman call error occurs.)
* In the other case than the serviceman call error, entering the simula-
tion is inhibited during the system check operation is displayed.
Note: Executable only when the PCL is installed.
67-20
Function Used to check the network connection when the
(Purpose) scanner option is installed.
Operation/procedure
The network scanner is checked.
1. Press the [START] key.
PLEASE SEND DATA and READY are displayed. (When the
PCL board is installed, it takes some time to display READY.)
2. Boot ftp from MS-DOS.
Data are sent from the PC by the put file name.
The process is displayed. Check the display.
(TEST DATA)
TEST DATA
(Process status)
RECEIVE
TESTING
After completion, the result is displayed.
When the simulation is completed normally, COMPLETE is displayed.
(No display for abnormal completion.)
Pressing [CA] key cancels the simulation resets the operation.
* Execution of the simulation which performs communication with the
PCL board is inhibited until Notice Page storage is completed. (Only
when the serviceman call error occurs.)
* In the other case than the serviceman call error, entering the simula-
tion is inhibited during the system check operation is displayed.
Note: Executable only when PCL and NIC are installed.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N SIMULATION 6 - 43
[7] SELF DIAG AND TROUBLE CODE
1. Trouble code list Trouble code
Trouble
Main Sub Trouble contents
Trouble code detection
Trouble code code
Main Sub Trouble contents
detection F9 00 Printer PWB communication trouble MCU
code code
10 Printer PWB trouble
A0 01 Security incompatibility error
80 Printer PWB communication trouble
E1 00 IMC PWB communication trouble MCU (Protocol)
10 IMC PWB trouble 81 Printer PWB communication trouble
11 IMC PWB ASIC error (Parity)
12 IMC PWB CODEC IC error 82 Printer PWB communication trouble
13 IMC PWB flash ROM error (Overrun)
14 IMC PWB expaned memory module 84 Printer PWB communication trouble
(DIMM) error (Framing)
15 IMC PWB page memory error 88 Printer PWB communication trouble
/SRAM error (Time-out)
16 IMC PWB standard compression memory 96 MCU and PCL PWB communication
error versions discrepancy error
17 IMC PWB smoothing IC error 99 Printer PWB language error
80 IMC PWB communication trouble H2 00 Main heater lamp thermistor open hard
(protocol) detection
81 IMC PWB communication trouble 01 Sub heater lamp thermistor open hard
(Parity) detection
82 IMC PWB communication trouble H3 00 Main heater lamp abnormally high
(Overrun) temperature hard detection trouble
84 IMC PWB communication trouble 01 Sub heater lamp abnormally high
(Framing) temperature hard detection trouble
88 IMC PWB communication trouble 10 Main heater lamp abnormally high
(Time-out) temperature soft detection trouble
E7 02 LSU trouble 11 Sub heater lamp abnormally high
10 CCD black level error temperature soft detection trouble
11 CCD white level error H4 00 Main heater lamp abnormally low
temperature detection
12 Shading trouble
01 Sub heater lamp abnormally low
F1 00 Finisher communication trouble FIN
temperature detection
03 Delivery roller lift motor trouble
20 Main heater lamp abnormally low
10 Staple motor trouble temperature detection
15 Tray lift motor trouble 21 Sub heater lamp abnormally low
19 Paper alignment motor F trouble temperature detection
20 Paper alignment motor R trouble H5 01 10 times of continuous detection of the
37 RAM data trouble lower paper exit sensor (POD1) lead edge
50 Incompatible trouble jam or the upper paper exit sensor
(POD2) lead edge jam or the duplex
95 Paper exit option configuration error sensor (PPD2) rear edge jam
F2 02 Toner supply failure L1 00 Scanner feed trouble
04 Identification error L3 00 Scanner return trouble
Model error L4 01 Main motor trouble
Type error 11 Shifter motor trouble
Destination error 31 Fusing fan lock trouble
Data abnormality 32 Power (back up) fan lock trouble
Misc error 33 Paper exit fan lock trouble
05 CRUM chip communication error L6 10 Polygon motor trouble
58 Temperature humidity sensor abnormality L8 10 Power abnormality detection trouble
F5 02 Copy lamp (xenon lamp) error U1 01 FAX battery error
F6 00 FAX control PWB communication trouble MCU 02 PANEL LOW battery error
10 FAX control PWB trouble U2 04 EEPROM communication error
80 FAX control PWB communication trouble 20 Machine speed code data error
(Protocol)
U7 00 RIC communication trouble
81 FAX control PWB communication trouble
(Parity)
82 FAX control PWB communication trouble
(Overrun)
84 FAX control PWB communication trouble
(Framing)
88 FAX control PWB communication trouble
(Time-out)
96 Combination error between the MCU and
the FAX firmware.
99 FAX control PWB destination error
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 1
(For 31cpm)
: Check (Check, clean, replace or adjust according to necessity.)
: Cleaning : Replace : Lubricate
Unit Parts 100k 150k 200k 300k 400k 450k 500k 600k Note
Process Drum
Cleaner blade
Seal F/R
Drum frame unit Usable for three PM cycles
(Toner reception sheet)
MC unit
Separation pawl unit
Star ring
DV Developer
Toner filter unit
DV blade
DV side sheet F
DV side sheet R
Toner sensor
Fusing Upper heat roller
Lower heat roller
Upper separation pawl
Upper cleaning pad
Lower separation pawl
Thermistor
Fuser gear
Upper heat roller bearing
Lower fuser bearing
Thermistor cleaning pad
Paper guide
Paper feed Pickup roller Changing criteria for parts: 100k
Paper feeding sheet
Pickup roller and feed roller
(RSPF)
Transport Transport roller unit
Gear
Others Paper feed rollers
Gears
Ozone filter
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 2
2. Details of Maintenance Unit Parts
L. Drive section (1) DUP reverse motor
(2) Main drive motor
Unit Parts
(3) Toner motor
A. Process unit (1) Drum (4) PS transport clutch
(2) Drum section a. Main charger (5) Paper feed clutch
b. Cleaning blade
(6) Drive unit
c. Drum frame unit (7) Lift up motor
d. Moquette F/R M. Transport section (1) Transport roller
e. Separation pawl
N. Operation section (1) Operation section
B. Developing unit (1) Developer (2) OPU PWB
(2) Toner filter unit (3) Key PWB
(3) DV side sheet F/ DV side sheet R
(4) LCD unit
(4) DV blade O. Switch (1) Power switch
(5) Toner sensor P. RSPF (1) Document tray a. Document tray unit
C. Fusing section (1) Thermostat section b. Document length
(2) Thermistor sensor
(3) Paper guide c. Document width
(4) Fusing separation pawl (lower) resistor PWB
(5) Lower heat roller (2) Paper feed unit a. Paper feed clutch
(6) Heater lamp section b. Pickup roller
(7) Upper cleaning pad c. Paper feed roller
(8) Fusing separation pawl (upper) d. Paper feed unit
(9) Upper heat roller e. Separation sheet
(10) Thermistor cleaning pad f. Sensor
D. Optical section (1) CCD unit (3) Transport a. Transport unit
(2) Lamp unit a. Lamp section b. PS clutch
b. PWB c. Pressure release
c. Wire solenoid
d. Mirror motor d. RSPF motor
E. Paper feed (1) Paper feed solenoid e. Transport roller
section (2) Tray sensor PWB f. Roller
(3) Manual P-in sensor/Manual empty sensor g. Sensor
(4) Multi manual a. Paper feed roller/ h. Roller
paper feed pickup roller i. Roller
b. Reverse sensor (4) Base section a. Interface PWB
c. Separation sheet b. Solenoid
d. Clutch/solenoid c. Book sensor
(5) Upper 500 a. Paper feed roller/ d. Sensor
sheets tray pickup roller
paper feed b. Separation sheet
A. Process unit
(6) Lower 500 a. Paper feed roller/ (Note for servicing the OPC drums)
sheets tray pickup roller 1. Prevention of oily dirt attachment
paper feed b. Separation sheet Note:
c. Lift up unit Be careful not to attach fingerprints or oily dirt on the OPC drum sur-
d. Transport clutch face. (Keep the unit away from oils and dust.)
e. Paper feed clutch When replacing the OPC drum, cover the OPC drum with the protec-
f. Transport clutch tion sheet and hold the protection sheet.
g. Solenoid If it is required to hold the OPC drum directly, use enough care not to
h. Sensor PWB touch the cleaning blade area, 5mm inside from both edges of the
F. Side door unit (1) Transport roller unit OPC drum. (If a fingerprint or oily dirt is attached to the cleaning
blade area of the OPC drum, the cleaning blade may flip.)
(2) Transport roller
(3) DUP transport roller 5mm
(4) DUP motor
G. 1st paper exit unit (1) Cooling fan
(2) Exit roller
H. Laser unit (1) LSU
5mm
I. Power unit (1) Power source
J. PWB (1) Option CN PWB
(2) IMC PWB
(3) MCU PWB
(4) Motherboard PWB
(5) Second interface PWB
K. Ozone filter
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 3
[Countermeasures] (2) Drum section
If a fingerprint is attached to the OPC drum surface erroneously, a. Main charger
perform the following countermeasures.
1) Use dry cloth to clean and remove the dirt. 1
4
2) Apply KYNAR to prevent blade flip.
[Check method] 1
2
Check to confirm that the OPC drum is free from fingerprints or oily dirt
and that the cleaning blade is completely cleaned by the following
method.
Make a print of a half tone image on all the surface of A4 (11" x 8.5")
paper, and check the printed paper for any abnormality in the image.
2. Prior exposure prevention
Note:
Avoid servicing in a place where there is strong light.
Do not expose the unit to light for a long time.
Cover the OPC drum with light-blocking material. (When using
paper, use about 10 sheets of paper to block light.)
[Countermeasures]
If the OPC drum is erroneously exposed to light too much (prior expo- 3
sure), perform the following countermeasures.
1) Print half tone images on the whole surface of A4 (11" x 8.5") b. Cleaning blade
paper, and check to confirm that there is no irregular density area 1
in the previously exposed section.
2) Damages due to prior exposure may be recovered by keeping the
OPC drum for several hours. If, however, image are not recovered,
replace the OPC drum.
(1) Drum
2
1 2
4
3
c. Drum frame unit
Note: When installing the process unit in the main unit after replacing
the drum, process unit may not be able to install by reason of the
drum drive coupling position.
In this case, rotate the drum about 45 degrees and install again.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 4
d. Moquette F/R B. Developing section
(1) Developer
Note: If it disturbs the blade movement, replace it and attach new one.
e. Separation pawl
Disassembly* Hold the tip of the separation pawl and remove it.
Assembly* Press the center of the separation pawl and install it.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 5
(2) Toner filter unit (4) DV blade
[Cross-section]
Bump 0
reference
0.5
0.5 0
Rib reference
Clean the sensor only after removing used DV when replacing DV.
[DV side sheet F/ DV side sheet R attachment reference]
C. Fusing section
0 0 3
Molt Molt
edge 2
edge
reference reference
0.3 0.3
1
0.5 0 0 0.5
Projection edge Projection edge
reference reference
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 6
(3) Paper guide
(1) Thermostat
Note: When securing the lamp harness and the thermostat, the
tightening torque of the screw (4 positions) is 6-9 kgs.
(4) Fusing separation pawl (lower)
2
2
1 4
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 7
(8) Fusing separation pawl (upper)
3
2
3
2 1
2 2
1
(9) Upper heat roller
1
(6) Heater lamp
1
2
2
3
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 8
D. Optical section
(1) CCD unit 2
1 1
3 1 1
1
2
1 2
3
3
1 1 4
2
1
3
5
4
4
2
3
1
a. Lamp
3
(2) Lamp unit 2
1
3 1
1
1 2
6
1
b. PWB
5
2 1
3
4
4 2
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 9
c. Wire (1) Paper feed solenoid
1 3
2 3
3 2
d. Mirror motor
3
A
2 B
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 10
c. Separation sheet
1)
1 2
2)
5
6
3)
3 4
6
5
4
2 3
2
2 1
3
LOCK
2
1
2
4
b. Reverse sensor 1
2 (Solenoid)
3
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 11
(Clutch) (5) Upper 500 sheets tray paper feed
a. Paper feed roller/pickup roller
A
A
A A
1
4
3 2
1
3
Note: With the toner cartridge installed, do not tilt or shake the devel-
oper cartridge.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 12
4
1
3
2 4
b. Separation sheet
1
3
3
4
1 2 3
2 1
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 13
1 1
1)
3
2 2
4
2
b. Separation sheet
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 14
c. Lift up unit
1
1
3
d. Transport clutch
2
g. Solenoid
1
2 1
3
3
2
1
3
2 2
3
f. Transport clutch
Check that two springs are securely inserted into the transfer roller
unit bosses.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 15
(2) Transport roller (4) DUP motor
2 4
1 1
1
2
3
3
3 2
1
2
1
3
2
3
4 1
1
3 1
2
2 1
5
3
4
5
3 2
1
2
1
2
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 16
(2) Exit roller
2 2
2
2
1 1
3
1
4
1
3 2
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 17
2
1
1
1
2
1
2
H. Laser unit
Note: Do not disassemble the LSU unit.
1 (1) LSU
1) Turn OFF the machine power, and disconnect the power plug from
the power outlet.
2) Remove the left cabinet and exit tray.
3) Disconnect the LSU connector, and remove the securing screws to
remove the LSU.
Note: Check to confirm that the solenoid shaft is in the gate bracket,
and fix with the screw.
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 18
2
2
1 2
1
2
2
2 3
2
2
I. Power unit
(1) Power source
2
J. PWB
(1) Option CN PWB
1
1
3
1 2 1
1
1
3
4
1 2 3
2
2
2
3
2 1
1
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 19
(2) IMC PWB (4) Motherboard PWB
1
2
1 1
1
3
3 1
3
2
4
3
1
2
3
1
1
2
1
1
2
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 20
(5) Second interface PWB
2 3
2
1
2
1
K. Ozone filter
1
2
1
3
1
2 3
1
3
1
1
2
1
1
2
1
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 21
Note: Before removing the left cover, remove the No.1 tray in advance. (3) Toner motor
L. Drive section
(1) DUP reverse motor
3
4
1
3
2
2
(2) Main drive motor 1
2
1
3
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 22
(5) Paper feed clutch (7) Lift up motor
3 1
1
2
3 2
2
1
3 1
4
3
3
2 2
2
1
2
1
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 23
(2) OPU PWB
2
3 1
N. Operation section
(1) Operation section
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 24
(4) LCD unit P. RSPF
(1) Document tray section
a. Document tray unit
2
2
2
O. Switch
2
(1) Power switch
2 4
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 25
b. Document length sensor (2) Paper feed unit section
a. Paper feed clutch
2
1
1
1
2
2
b. Pickup roller
3
1
2 2
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 26
c. Paper feed roller d. Paper feed unit
1
2
2
3
e. Separation sheet
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 27
f. Sensor b. PS clutch
3
2
1
2
1 1
d. RSPF motor
3 2
2
1
1
3
1
1
1
2
1 1
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 28
f. Roller
2
1
2
1
1
<Note for disassembling the motor>
The motor is positioned by the jig. Use the mark when assembling
it to the original position.
e. Transport roller
1 1
1 2
g. Sensor
2
3
2
1
1
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 29
h. Roller (4) Base section
a. Interface PWB
1 1 1
1 2
b. Solenoid
1 1
2
4 3
4
2
1 3
2 N
O R GI
I
i. Roller
1 3
1
2
c. Book sensor
1 2 3
2
1
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 30
d. Sensor
1 2
MX-M260/M310/M260N/M310N MAINTENANCE 8 - 31
[9] FIRMWARE UPDATE A. Firmware update method
(for Copier, and fax firm)
1. Firmware update procedure Following operational procedures are for:
Copier firm
(Necessary items for update) fax firm
A Personal computer
1) Make sure copier is off, and connect it to PC with download cable
B RS232C cross cable (D-sub 9pin to D-sub 9pin, or D-sub 25pin to beforehand.
D-sub 9pin)
2) Start up the maintenance program on PC. Select the model name
C Software for version-up from the model selection dialogue box.
(ROM type)
The flash ROM is directly installed to each PWB.
(Target PWB)
1 MCU PWB
2 Panel PWB
3 IMC PWB
4 Finisher PWB
PC 3) Make sure only "Printer Control Board" tree is visible under "Simu-
C lation Command List".
A
Download
data
RS232C connector
(9pin or 25pin)
B
RS232C cross cable
(D-sub 9pin to D-sub 9pin)
or
(D-sub 25pin to D-sub 9pin)
Operation IMC
Finisher
panel PWB 4) Turn on the copier. The machine starts up in the download mode.
5) Additional tree will be visible when downloading maintenance pro-
2 3 4 gram on PC.
Make sure to start up maintenance program before turn on the
machine.
Prepare following files necessary for program update
Maintenance software: maintenance.exe
Andromeda module file: ProcModelP.mdl
USB communication program: JGRtoPRN.exe
Maintenance tool driver: SFZEJENU.inf
Ready to start download process
when these trees appear.
INNER
RSPF Paper Out Sensor Scanner Mirror HP Delivery Tray Upper Limit Detector Paper Transport Motor
RSPF Paper Width Sens (Analog) Cover Sensor Paper Level Detector Stalpe Motor
RSPF BOOK Sens Sensor Option Paper Pass Detector Tray Lift Motor
D-Sub 25pin Connector PWB D-Sub 15pin Paper Rear Edge Detector C Rear Edge Take-up Roller Solenoid
L1
Paper Rear Edge Detector F Paper Pass Gate Solenoid
FINISHER PWB
Copy-Lamp
1. Block diagram
2nd POUT
Staple Lead Detector Stapler Cooling Fan
Defog Staple Home Position Sensor Paper Entry Gate
Sensor
Paper Size Sensor
CCD-PWB
Solenoid
Heater Staple Tray Paper Detector Safety Switch
Paper Full
Pout 2 Ssensor
Pout Gate
AB INCH
COVER SENSOR
RSPF-Motor RSPF-Pressure RSPF-DupSOL
release SOL
A. SYSTEM BLOCK DIAGRAM
CN21
Fuser Cooling Fan (x 2) Pout Sensor
CN6
CN32
CN22
CN26
CN25
CN23
CN30
CN31
(AB / INCH )
CPLD Writer
Shifter-Motor CN2 CN505
Except North America
Duplex 2 Motor
CN4
FAX PWB
Pout Cooling Fan (x 2) CN504
CN
Duplex-Motor CN1
CN7
MCU-PWB IMC PWB
Duplex Conveyance Sensor Humidity Sensor CN503 256/512MB DIMM (x 2)
SPLC PWB
2nd tray Unit (Optional)
CS interface PWB
CN8
CN3
CSS2H: Casette Detector
CN19
CN28
CN27
CN501
CN38
CN14
CN29
CN9
PCL2H: Pick Up Clutch CN15 CN18
USB
33MHz/32bit
EBIF
B. PCL PWB BLOCK DIAGRAM
MEMD[31:16]
MEMD[15:0]
USB SWITCH DATA[63:0] MEMD[63:0]
Connector
G-Bus
BD6513F-E2
PCI Connector
PCI Connector
PCIC
(JAPAN ONLY)
EBUSC PIO Serial EEPROM
MEMD[31:0]
Bridge
256Kbit
BUSSPRT
ETHER Ether
LCX244
LCX245
Connector MacPHYter II
IM-Bus
ACE
UART IRC
3.3V
LCH
slot3 32MB
LCX373
(Code)
(Option)
slot2 8MB
slot1 16MB
(Boot,ESC/P)
Flash SO-DIMM
Flash SO-DIMM
Flash SO-DIMM
UART Ch1
UART Ch0
LA[20:0]
LD[31:0]
LCX244
4Pin Connector
(RS-232C Connector)
Image RTC
USB USB1.1 Cont I/F
Connector ML60852A
USBCLK
IO I/F PIO
RESETCLK
OSC
12MHz
2. Actual wiring chart
A. MCU - Panel unit, Optical base plate sensor section (P1)
CN9(52207-1885) CN1(52610-1871)
DGND 18 18 DGND
TOUCH PANEL
24V1 17 17 +24V_OP
DGND 16 16 DGND
+5V 15 15 +5V
DGND 14 14 DGND CN4(52271-0469)
+3.3V 13 13 +3.3V X2/ 1
+3.3V 12 12 +3.3V Y2/ 2
RES_OPU 11 11 RES_OPU X1 3
FPC
/CLK_OPU 10 10 /CLK_OPU Y1 4
CRDY_OPU 9 9 CRDY_OPU
SRDY_OPU 8 8 SRDY_OPU
/TXD_OPU 7 7 /TXD_OPU
/RXD_OPU 6 6 /RXD_OPU
DGND 5 5 DGND
Standby_LED 4 4 Standby_LED
OPU PWB
/WakeUp_Key 3 3 /WakeUp_Key
+5Vsub 2 2 +5Vsub
DGND 1 1 DGND
PANEL UNIT
CN2(52271-2479)
CN1(IMSA-9619S-24C-TB)
GND 24 24 GND
INFO_LED 23 23 INFO_LED
/START_KEY 22 22 /START_KEY
SENSE0 21 21 SENSE0 CN5(52746-1571) CN**(*****)
SENSE1 20 20 SENSE1 V0 1 1 V0
SENSE2 19 19 SENSE2 LP 2 2 LP
SENSE3 18 18 SENSE3 D-GND 3 3 D-GND
SENSE4 17 17 SENSE4 CP 4 4 CP
SCAN0 16 16 SCAN0 D-GND 5 5 D-GND
LCD UNIT
SCAN1 15 15 SCAN1 M 6 6 M
SCAN2 14 14 SCAN2 3.3V_EXT 7 7 3.3V_EXT
SCAN3 13 13 SCAN3 D0 8 8 D0
KEY PWB
SCAN4 12 12 SCAN4 D1 9 9 D1
/SEG0 11 11 /SEG0 D-GND 10 10 D-GND
/SEG1 10 10 /SEG1 D2 11 11 D2
/SEG2 9 9 /SEG2 D3 12 12 D3
/SEG3 8 8 /SEG3 D-GND 13 13 D-GND
COM0 7 7 COM0 DISP 14 14 DISP
COM1 6 6 COM1 VEE 15 15 VEE
COM2 5 5 COM2
/BZR_PWM 4 4 /BZR_PWM CN6
START_LED 3 3 START_LED (SM02(8.0)
5Vsub 2 2 5Vsub B-BHS-1-TB)
GND 1 1 GND CCFT+ 1
/CCFT 2
MCU PWB
AB ONLY
PAPER SIZE SENSOR
(AB ONLY)
5V 10 4 5V
DGND 12 5 DGND
DSCLK# 14 6 DSCLK
DSIN3 16 7 DSIN0
DSIN2A 19 (N.C) 8 N.C
DSIN2B 20 (N.C) 292250-8
DGND 21 (N.C)
DGND 22 (N.C)
DSCLK# 23 (N.C)
DSCLK# 24 (N.C)
5V 25 (N.C) OC COVER SENSOR
5V 26 (N.C) 1 OC COVER
LED0# 27 (N.C) 2 DGND
LED0# 28 (N.C) 3 PULL UP
OCCOVER 29 292250-3
DGND 30
5V(PULL UP) 31 MHP SENSOR
5V(PULL UP) 32 3 PULL UP
MHP 33 2 MHP
DGND 34 1 DGND
S3B-PH-K-S
CN23(B34B-PHDSS-B)
INCH ONLY
/ABJP 1 (N.C)
DGND 2 (N.C) PAPER SIZE SENSOR
LED1# 3 (N.C) (INCH ONLY)
LED1# 4 (N.C)
Sub scanning side
LED2# 5 (N.C)
1 DSIN2A
LED2# 6 (N.C)
2 DGND
LED3# 7 (N.C)
3 DSCLK#
LED3# 8 (N.C)
4 5V
5V 9 (N.C)
5 LED0#
5V 10 (N.C)
292250-8
DGND 11 (N.C)
DGND 12 (N.C)
DSCLK# 13 (N.C)
Main scanning side
DSCLK# 14 (N.C)
1 DSIN2B
DSIN0 15 (N.C)
2 DGND
DSIN3 16 (N.C)
3 DSCLK#
/INCHJP 17
4 5V
DGND 18
5 LED0#
DSIN2A 19
292250-8
DGND 21
DSCLK# 23
5V 25
LED0# 27
DSIN2B 20
DGND 22 OC COVER SENSOR
DSCLK# 24 1 OC COVER
5V 26 2 DGND
LED0# 28 3 PULL UP
OCCOVER 29 292250-3
DGND 30
5V(PULL UP) 31 MHP SENSOR
5V(PULL UP) 32 3 PULL UP
MHP 33 2 MHP
DGND 34 1 DGND
S3B-PH-K-S
CCD PWB
/DUMC 8 25 /DUMC
/PB 7 26 /PB CN32(B16B-PHDSS-B)
/OB 6 27 /OB N.C 7 (N.C)
5V 5 28 5V N.C 9 (N.C)
DGND 4 29 DGND N.C 11 (N.C)
12V 3 30 12V [1st PAPER EXIT UNIT]
DGND 2 31 DGND
12V 1 32 12V
MCU PWB
<PAPER OUT GATE SL>
12 24V_RSPF SPFGSOL# 21 22 SPFGSOL# /PGSOL2 3
13 DGND SPFPSOL# 22 21 SPFPSOL#
14 PGND SPFPAPER 23 24 SPFPAPER
15 YSPF 5V 24 23 5V CN1(B5B-PAEK-1) Blue
16 DGND PGND 25 26 PGND SW24V / SW24V_Dup 1
17 SPFMODB# 24VOP 26 25 24V1 DPXA 2
18 SPFWS DPXB 3 <DUPLEX MOTOR>
19 3.3V1 /DPXA 4
20 SELA# /DPXB 5
OP I/F PWB
7 24V_FN FINCMD 13 14 FINCMD CN4(B5B-PH-K-R) Red
8 PGND /RESET# 14 13 /RESET# SW24V 1
9 DGND FINPIN 15 16 /MSFINDET DUP2MODA# 2
10 3.3V1 /FINDET 16 15 /FINDET DUP2MODB# 3
FINISHER
<DUPLEX 2 MOTOR>
11 /FINSRDY PGND 17 18 PGND /DUP2MODA# 4
12 FINCMD 24VOP 18 17 24V1 /DUP2MODB# 5
13 5V1
14 /FINDET
15 DGND
CN903(SUB-D9)
1 N.C
2 SVCMDX
3 SVSTSX
4 DTRX
5 DGND
6 DSRX
7 RTSX
8 CTSX
9 N.C
292250-2
1 HPTRAY1 <HAND PAPER TRAY 1>
HARNESS GUIDE 2 DGND
BU15P-TR-P-H 292250-2
15 24V 1 1 HPTRAY2
14 /HPSOL 2 2 DGND
<HAND PAPER TRAY 2>
13 HPTRAY1 3
12 DGND 4
11 HPTRAY2 5
10 DGND 6 292250-3
9 HPSIZE1 7 1 HPSIZE1
8 DGND 8 2 DGND <HAND PAPER PICK SIZE SENSOR 1>
CN15(B36B-PUDSS-1) 7 PULL UP 9 3 PULL UP
24V 5 6 HPSIZE2 10
/HPSOL 7 5 DGND 11
4 PULL UP 12 292250-3
HPTRAY1 9 3 3.3V 13 1 HPSIZE2
DGND 11 2 HPWS 14 2 DGND <HAND PAPER SIZE SENSOR 2>
HPTRAY2 13 1 DGND 15 3 PULL UP
DGND 15 PHNR-15-H PHNR-15-H
HPSIZE1 17
DGND 19 S 3B-PH-K-S
5V(PULL UP) 21 1 3.3V
HPSIZE2 23 2 HPWS <HAND PAPER WIDTH SENSOR>
DGND 25 3 DGND
5V(PULL UP) 27
3.3V 29
HPWS 31
DGND 33
DGND 10 BU03P-TR-P-H S 3B-PH-K-S
DUP2SEN 12 1 DGND 3 1 DGND
C. Manual feed, 1st tray unit section (P3)
SMP-03V-NC SMR-03V-N
24V 3 1 24V 1
PSRSOL/ 4 2 N.C 2 <PAPER STOP ROLLER CLUCH>
3 /PSRSOL 3
BU04P-TR-P-H
1 /HPIN 4 292250-3 VHPSG2481++-1
/HPIN 26 2 N.C 3 1 /HPIN
DGND 28 3 DGND 2 2 DGND <HAND PAPER IN
5V(PULL UP) 30 4 PULL UP 1 3 PULL UP
HPEMPTY 16 PHNR-4-H PHNR-4-H
SENSOR PWB>
DGND 18
5V(PULL UP) 20 BU05P-TR-P-H 292250-3 VHPSG2481++-1
CSS1H 22 1 HPEMPTY 5 1 /HPEMPTY <HAND PAPER
MCU PWB
DGND 24 2 DGND 4 2 DGND
3 PULL UP 3 3 PULL UP EMPTY SENSOR PWB>
4 CSS1H 2
5 DGND 1
PHNR-5-H PHNR-5-H
SMR-02V-N SMP-02V-NC
1 24V 1
2 /PCS1H 2 <PAPER FEED SOLENOID>
CN14(B8B-PH-K-S)
24V 1
/PCS1H 2 B 6B-PH-K-S
DGND 3 1 DGND <PAPER PATH SENSOR>
/PIN 4 2 /PIN <PAPER EMPTY SENSOR>
5V 5 3 5V <PAPER UPPER LIMIT SENSOR>
<TRAY SENSOR PWB>
/PAP1H 6 4 /PAP1H
N.C 7 (N.C) 5 N.C
/LUD1H 8 6 /LUD1H
D. 2nd tray unit section (P4)
CN2(B3B-PH-K-K) Black
/TRCL2 1
N.C 2 (N.C) <VERTICAL TRANSPORT ROLLER CL>
24V 3
CN7(B3B-PH-K-E) Blue
CSS2 1 292250-2
N.C 2 1 CSS2 <TRAY SENSOR SW>
DGND 3 2 DGND
CN20(B10B-PH-K-S)
1 24VOP
(N.C) 2 24VOP
(N.C) 3 24VOP
(N.C) 4 +3.3V
5 +5V
6 D-GND LVPS PWB (1/2)
7 D-GND
(N.C) 8 P-GND
(N.C) 9 P-GND
10 P-GND
CN12(B10B-PASK-1) CN1(B11B-PH-K-S)
DGND 1 9 DGND #187(B1)[RD]
SW24V 2 11 SW24V MHV - MHV SOKET
TCDA# 3 3 TCDA#
DHVREM/ 4 4 DHVREM CN21(B2P-VH_BL_Blue)
THV-REM/ 5 6 THV-REM MCCASE 1
DVBSPWM/ 6 8 DVBSPWM N.C 2 MCCASE
MHVREM/ 7 1 MHVREM
THVREM 8 5 THVREM CN101(B2P-VH_White)
GBPWM/ 9 2 GBPWM GB 1
DVBSREM/ 10 7 DVBSREM N.C 2 GB
(N.C) 10 N.C
#187(B201)[WH]
THV - - THV
TC HIGH VOLTAGE
CN301(B2P-VH_BK_Black)
DHV 1 - DHV
HOLDER
HV PWB
N.C 2
CN401(B2P-VH_RD_Red)
DVBS 1 (To P06)
CN10(B30B-PUDSS-1) GND 2
24V1 11
E. Fusing unit, Power supply unit section (P5)
P-GND 5
D-GND 14
CN19(S7B-PH-K-S) D-GND 16 CN101(B30B-PNDZS-1)
+12V 21 1 +12V
3.3Vsub 28 3 Sub3.3V
+3.3V 22 5 +3.3V
MCU PWB
RTH1
RTH2
PDPX
DGND
DGND
DGND
5V(PullUp)
+3.3V 20 7 +3.3V
+5V 18 9 +5V
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
D-GND 30 11 D-GND
D-GND 26 13 D-GND
D-GND 2 19 D-GND
[FUSING UNIT] +24V 3 21 +24V
P-GND 8 23 P-GND
/PR 9 25 /PR
FW 13 27 FW
POFFR# 15 29 P-OFF 172076-1
<DUPLEX PAPER OUT SENSOR> 5Vsub 25 2 Sub5V or
292250-3 BU03P-TR-P-H 3.3Vsub 27 4 Sub3.3V PS-250
5V(PullUp) 3 1 5V(PullUp) 3 +3.3V 24 6 +3.3V CN2(B03P-VL-R)
White
DGND 2 2 DGND 2 +5V 17 8 +5V AC-NEUT OUT 3 SW OUT (NEUTRAL) 1
PDPX 1 3 PDPX 1 D-GND 29 10 D-GND N.C 2
Black
RHNR-3-H RHNR-3-H D-GND 23 12 D-GND AC-LIVE OUT 1 SW OUT (LIVE) 1
D-GND 19 14 D-GND
D-GND 1 16 D-GND <AC SW>
+24VINT 6 18 +24VINT CN3(B03P-VL-B)
BU04P-TR-P-H +24VINT 4 20 +24VINT AC-LIVE IN 1 Black SW IN (LIVE) 1
1 RTH1 4 P-GND 7 22 P-GND N.C 2
White SW IN (NEUTRAL) 1
2 DGND 3 HLOUT2 12 28 HLOUT2 AC-NEUT IN 3
3 RTH2 2 HLOUT1 10 30 HLOUT1
4 DGND 1 (N.C) 15 D-GND CN102(B3B-PH-K-S)
RHNR-4-H RHNR-4-H (N.C) 17 D-GND /PSFAN 1 (N.C) 172076-7(RED)
(N.C) 24 P-GND N.C 2 (N.C) or
(N.C) 26 FAN-C GND 3 (N.C) PS-250-R(RED)
CN1(B03P-VL)
LIVE 1
THERMISTER 1 N.C 2
NEUTRAL 3
FGND
THERMISTER 2
CN1(B03P-VL)
LIVE 1 Brown
N.C 2
HARNESS GUIDE
NEUTRAL 3 White
VLP-02V VLR-02V CN5(B2P-VL)
HEATER LAMP 1 (CENTER) 1 LIVE1 1 1 LIVE1
2 HL-OUTPUT1 2 2 LIVE2 FGND
LVPS PWB (2/2)
CN6(B2P3-VH)
VLP-03V VLR-03V 1 HL-OUTPUT1
1 LIVE2 1 2 N.C
2 N.C 2 3 HL-OUTPUT2
3 HL-OUTPUT2 3
SMR-03V-N SMP-03V-NC
1 /PSFANOUT 1 3 /PSFANOUT
<PS FAN 2 (FRONT)> 3 PSFANRDY 3 2 PSFANRDY
2 PGND 2 1 PGND
<MAIN MOTOR>
CN8(B5B-PH-K-S) (B5B-PH-K-S)
SW24V 5 1 SW24V
CN502(B14B-PUDSS-1) PGND 4 2 PGND
(N.C) 10 OZNFANOUT /MMD 3 3 /MMD
(N.C) 12 OZNFANRDY /MMRDY 2 4 /MMRDY
(N.C) 14 PGND /MMCLK 1 5 /MMCLK
13 DGND
11 TRAY PAPER
9 5V(PULL UP)
GP1S73P BU03P-TR-P-H
DGND 2 1 DGND 3
TRAY PAPER 1 2 TRAY PAPER 2 CN3(B2P-VH)
F. DV & LSU unit section (P6)
P05
(To HV PWB)
51010-0811 52025-0811
8 DVBS 8
7 N.C 7
6 DGND 6
5 DEV 5
4 N.C 4
3 N.C 3
TCS 2 TONER 2
1 24V 1 2 DGND
4 DEV CN504(B06B-CZHK-B-1) CK03-6H-P
31 CPM model only
6 TONER /POUTFANOUT 6 3 POUTFANOUT 1
(TSHP-04V-K) (THSR-04V-K) 8 24V POUTFANRDY 5 2 POUTFANRDY 2
4 DGND 4 1 DGND PGND 4 1 PGND 3 <POUT FAN 1>
3 3 3 3
MCU PWB
5V 5V /POUTFANOUT
CRUM PWB 2 DEVCLK# 2 5 DEVCLK# POUTFANRDY 2
1 DEVID# 1 7 DEVID# PGND 1
CK03-6H-P
3 POUTFANOUT 1
2 POUTFANRDY 2
1 PGND 3 <POUT FAN 2>
LSU UNIT
CN11(B4B-PH-K-K)BLACK SMP-02V-NC SMR-02V-N
24V 1 1 24V 1
/PREMSOL 2 2 DGND 2 <SEPARATION PAWL SOLENOID>
N.C 3 (N.C)
CN501(B13B-PASK-1) DGND 4 (N.C)
B10B-PH-K-S BU12P-TR-P-H 1 SW5V
SW5V 4 1 SW5V 12 (N.C) 2 DGND
B3B-PH-K-S
DGND 3
BPC /SYNC 2
SW5V 1
177622-5
/PMCLK 1
/PMRDY 2
PM PWB /PMD 3
PGND 4
24V 5
G. Board to board section (1/2) (P7)
CN3(TX24-60R-12ST-H1) CN5(TX25-60R-12ST-H1E) CN7(TX25-60P-12ST-H1E)
3.3VSub 1 1 3.3VSub 5V 1
3.3VSub 2 2 3.3VSub 5V 2
24V 3 3 24V 3.3V 3
DGND 4 4 DGND 3.3V 4
DGND 5 5 DGND /MRESET 5
/SCLINE 6 6 /SCLINE /PWOFF 6
/READY 7 7 /READY /PRLINE 7
5V 8 8 5V /HSYNC 8
MCU PWB
/PCLDET 18 18 /PCLDET GDATA2 18
IMC PWB
PCLSTS 19 19 PCLSTS GDATA4 19
/PCLSRDY 20 20 /PCLSRDY GDATA6 20
/PCLREQ1P 21 21 /PCLREQ1P GDATA8 21
/PCLCS1P 22 22 /PCLCS1P GDATA10 22
/PCLREQ0P 23 23 /PCLREQ0P GDATA12 23
/PCLCS0P 24 24 /PCLCS0P GDATA14 24
/FAXDET 25 25 /FAXDET N.C 25
FAXSTS 26 26 FAXSTS /ESACK1P 26
/FAXSRDY 27 27 /FAXSRDY N.C 27
/FAXREQ0P 28 28 /FAXREQ0P /ESPRD 28
/FAXCS0P 29 29 /FAXCS0P /ESACK0P 29
3.3V 30 30 3.3V DGND 30
5Vsub 31 31 5Vsub 5V 31
EXTRS 32 32 EXTRS 5V 32
GND 33 33 GND 3.3V 33
GND 34 34 GND 3.3V 34
/MRESET 35 35 /MRESET N.C 35
/PWOFF 36 36 /PWOFF N.C 36
/PRLINE 37 37 /PRLINE /SCLINE 37
MOTHER PWB
/HSYNC 38 38 /HSYNC /READY 38
/PSSTS 39 39 /PSSTS DGND 39
GDATA0 40 40 GDATA0 DGND 40
GDATA2 41 41 GDATA2 DGND 41
GDATA4 42 42 GDATA4 N.C 42
GDATA6 43 43 GDATA6 /ESDET 43
GDATA8 44 44 GDATA8 ESSTS 44
GDATA10 45 45 GDATA10 /ESSRDY 45
GDATA12 46 46 GDATA12 DGND 46
GDATA14 47 47 GDATA14 GDATA1 47
/FAXWU 48 48 /FAXWU GDATA3 48
/GDIDET 49 49 /GDIDET GDATA5 49
PCLCMD 50 50 PCLCMD GDATA7 50
/PCLCRDY 51 51 /PCLCRDY GDATA9 51
/PCLPRD 52 52 /PCLPRD GDATA11 52
/PCLACK1P 53 53 /PCLACK1P GDATA13 53
/PCLACK0P 54 54 /PCLACK0P GDATA15 54
/FAXPAGE 55 55 /FAXPAGE N.C 55
FAXCMD 56 56 FAXCMD /ESREQ1P 56
/FAXCRDY 57 57 /FAXCRDY /ESCS1P 57
/FAXPRD 58 58 /FAXPRD /ESREQ0P 58
/FAXACK0P 59 59 /FAXACK0P /ESCS0P 59
3.3V 60 60 3.3V DGND 60
SRA-21T-3
4 3.3Vsub 5V 4 4 5V
5 /RESET 3.3V 5 5 3.3V
6 /PWOFF 3.3V 6 6 3.3V
PCL PWB or SPLC PWB
HANDSET
20 GDATA6 GDATA6 20 20 GDATA6
FAX PWB
SPLC PWB
DATA0 17
GDATA7 12
DATA2 18
GDATA9 13
DATA4 19
GDATA11 14
DATA6 20
GDATA13 15
DATA8 21
GDATA15 16
DATA10 22
/PRINTERWU 17
DATA12 23
/PCLDET 18
DATA14 24
PCLSTS 19
GND 25
/PCLSRDY 20
(NC) 26
/PCLREQ1P 21
PCLACK1P_ 27
/PCLCS1P 22
GND 28
/PCLREQ0P 23
PCLACK0P_ 29
/PCLCS0P 24
GND 30
/FAXDET 25
+5V 31
FAXSTS 26
+5V 32
/FAXSRDY 27
+3.3V 33
/FAXREQ0P 28
+3.3VMAIN 34
/FAXCS0P 29
PRINTWU_ 35
3.3V 30
PSSTS 36
5Vsub 31
(NC) 37
EXTRS 32
READY_ 38
GND 33
GND 39
GND 34
GND 40
/MRESET 35
GND 41
/PWOFF 36
(GND) 42
/PRLINE 37
PCLDETECT_ 43
/HSYNC 38
PCLSTS 44
/PSSTS 39
PCLSRDY_ 45
GDATA0 40
GND 46
GDATA2 41
DATA1 47
GDATA4 42
DATA3 48
GDATA6 43
DATA5 49
GDATA8 44
DATA7 50
MOTHER PWB
GDATA10 45
DATA9 51
GDATA12 46
DATA11 52
GDATA14 47
DATA13 53
/FAXWU 48
DATA15 54
/GDIDET 49
GND 55
PCLCMD 50
PCLREQ1P_ 56
/PCLCRDY 51
PCLCS1P_ 57
/PCLPRD 52
PCLREQ0P_ 58
/PCLACK1P 53
PCLCS0P_ 59
/PCLACK0P 54
GND 60
/FAXPAGE 55
FAXCMD 56
/FAXCRDY 57
/FAXPRD 58
/FAXACK0P 59
3.3V 60
CN1(TX24-100R-12ST-H1) CN3(TX25-100P-12ST-H1E) (Japan only)
+5V 1 1 +5V
+5V 2 2 +5V
PCIRST_ 3 3 PCIRST_
GND 4 4 GND
GND 5 5 GND CN9(TX24-60R-12ST-H1E) CN**(TX25-60P-12ST-H1) CN1(TX25-60P-12ST-H1)
GND 6 6 GND +5V 1 1 5Vsub 24V 1
GND 7 7 GND +5V 2 2 5Vsub 24V 2
GND 8 8 GND +3.3V 3 3 3.3Vsub 5V 3
GNT2_ 9 9 GNT2_ +3.3V 4 4 3.3Vsub 5V 4
REQ2_ 10 10 REQ2_ RESET_ 5 5 /RESET 3.3V 5
GNT4_ 11 11 GNT4_ PWOFF_ 6 6 /PWOFF 3.3V 6
REQ4_ 12 12 REQ4_ PRLINE_ 7 7 /PRLINE /RESET 7
GND 13 13 GND HSYNC_ 8 8 /HSYNC /PWOFF 8
GND 14 14 GND GND 9 9 GND /PRLINE 9
USB HOST PWB (Japan only)
Digital Multifunction System
MX-M260
MODEL MX-M310
CONTENTS
1 1(Exteriors 1) R 1(Fusing unit 1)
2 2(Exteriors 2) S 2(Fusing unit 2)
3 RSPF 1(RSPF Exteriors 1) T (Drive unit)
4 RSPF 2(RSPF Exteriors 2) U 1(1st delivery paper unit 1)
5 RSPF (RSPF Paper feeding section) V 2(1st delivery paper unit 2)
6 RSPF 1(RSPF Transport section 1) W (PWB section)
7 RSPF 2(RSPF Transport section 2) X (Rear frame section)
8 (Operation panel unit) Y 2nd (2nd exteriors)
9 (Frame section) Z 2nd 550 (2nd 550 cassette unit)
F (Lamp unit) [ 2nd (2nd paper feed section)
G 1(Optical frame 1) \ 2nd (2nd paper transfer section)
H 2(Optical frame 2) ] 2nd (2nd drive section)
I (Middle frame section) ^ (Lift up unit)
J 550 (550 cassette unit) _ (2nd delivery paper unit)
[Option for EX]
K (Paper feed section)
`
L (Paper transfer section) (Job-separater unit)[Option for EX]
M (Side door unit) a
(Packing material & accessories)
N
(Multi manual paper feed tray unit) b
(Job-separater Packing material &
O (Multi manual paper feed unit) accessories)[Option for EX]
P DV (DV unit) (Index)
Q (Process unit)
A :
B :
E :
D :
C :
DEFINITION
Rank A : Maintenance parts, and consumable parts which are not included in but closely related to maintenance parts
Rank B : Performance/function parts (sensors, clutches, and other electrical parts), consumable parts
Rank E : Unit parts including PWB
Rank D : Preparation parts (External fitting, packing, parts packed together)
Rank C : Parts other than the above (excluding sub components of PWB)
!
Because parts marked with "!" is indispensable for the machine safety maintenance and operation, it must be replaced with
the parts specific to the product specification.
F ( )
F Other than this Parts Guide, please refer to documents Service Manual(including Circuit Diagram)of this model.
F Please use the 13 digit code described in the right hand corner of front cover of the document, when you place an order.
F For U.S. only-Use order codes provided in advertising literature. Do not order from parts department.
1 1(Exteriors 1)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 GCAB-0081QST1 AL EB N D Optical left cabinet
2 GCAB-0080QST1 AM EG N D Optical right cabinet
3 CFIX-0013QS11 AM EG N D G lass fixing plate
4 PSHEZ0220QSZ1 AK DX C Shading sheet
5 LX-BZ0082QSPZ AA DD C Screw(38)
6 GCAB-0084QST1 AS EQ N D Rear cabinet upper
7 CGIDM0116QS05 AK DX N C OR guide unit OR
11 PGLSP0003QSZZ BA FX B Table glass
17 LFIX-0012QSAC AH DX N D SPF fixing glass SPF
18 PSHEZ0221QSZZ AC DJ C White revise sheet LPD LPD
19 PGLSP0004QSZZ AX FG B SPF slit glass SPF
20 PSHEZ0207QSZZ AC DJ C SPF glass sheet F SPF F
21 PSHEZ0222QSZZ AC DJ C Glass fixing sheet
22 PCUSS0011QSZZ AB DJ C Glass cushion
23 PSHEZ0208QSZZ AC DJ C Glass sheet R R
24 PCUSS0027QSZZ AA DJ C Glass cushion C C
26 PMLT-0093QSZZ AB DJ C Rear cabinet upper cushion
27 PSHEZ0474QSZZ AD DJ C Glass fixing sheet
1
1 1(Exteriors 1)
1 5
5
5
7
5 5
6
4 5
26 23
5
17
11
5 18
27
19 21
20 22 2
24
PRP03701 22
2
2 2(Exteriors 2)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 GCAB-0042QSTF AP EQ N D Rear cabinet left
3 XHBS730P08000 AB DD C Screw(38)
4 GCAB-0145QSZZ AU EZ N C Delivery tray cabinet rear
5 GCOV-0056QST1 AG DS N D Rear cabinet maintenance cover
6 GCAB-0043QSTC AM EG N D Rear cabinet lower
7 XEBS740P10000 AA DD C Screw(410)
8 GCAB-0085QST5 AY FQ N D Rear cabinet right
9 GCOV-0034QSTC AK DX N C Rear cabinet memory cover
10 PCOVP0130QSZZ AM EG N D Delivery dummy cover
11 MSPRD0189QSZZ AB DJ C Right cabinet spring
14 NROLP1060FCZZ AF DS C U-turn roller U
15 MSPRT0229GCAZ AC DJ C FU spring R FU R
17 GCOV-0043QST2 AX FG N D Option PWB cover
18 PFILZ0016QSZZ AS EQ B Ozone filter
19 GCOV-0086QSZZ AN EG N C Delivery cover
23 GCAB-0142QSZZ AL EB N C Front cabinet right
24 GCAB-0148QSZZ AW FG N C Right cabinet front
25 LBNDZ0007QSZZ AC DJ N C Front cabinet band A2R A2R
26 GCAB-0141QSZZ AT EZ N C Front cabinet
27 TLABZ5148FCZZ AC DJ D Energy star label
37 LX-BZ0082QSPZ AA DD C Screw(38)
39 TCAUA1069FCZZ AC DJ D Service caution label
49 MARMP0050QSZZ AF DS D Paper fixing arm
61 PSHEZ0568QSZZ AD DJ C R cabinet sheet
63 PCOVP0142QSZZ AE DS N C Fan cover
65 GCAB-0144QSZZ AK DX N C Delivery tray joint cabinet
66 PCOVP0144QSZZ AD DJ N C R cabinet lever cover
67 HBDGD0058FCZZ AT EQ C Front cabinet badge
CBDGD0062FC35 AH DX N C Model name plate [MX-M260]
68
CBDGD0062FC34 AH DX N C Model name plate [MX-M310]
69 PBOX-0006QSZ1 AE DS N D Delivery sensor BOX
70 XEBS730P10000 AC DD C Screw(310)
71 VHPGP1S73P+-18 AF DS B Photo sensor(GP1S73P)
72 MLEVP0068QSTZ AC DJ N C Delivery tray actuator
73 DHAI-0370QSPZ AF DS C Delivery paper detect sensor harness
74 GCAB-0143QSZZ BA FX N D Delivery tray cabinet
75 PSHEZ0392QSZ1 AB DJ N C Paper feed solenoid sound proof B B
3
2 2(Exteriors 2)
37
7 9 7
3
37
8
1
3
3
37
3
19 39
17 3 5
3 4
3
3 7 3
7
75
6
7 11
18 15
7 14
63 74 15
7 14
7
73
7 66
71 7
72
3 24
69
7
3 70 61
65
7
7 23 49 7
7
67
26 7
68 10
25 7
27 3 PRP03702
4
3 RSPF 1(RSPF Exteriors 1)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 GCAB-0075QST1 AR EQ N D Rear cabinet
2 XEBS740P12000 AA DD C Screw(412)
3 XHBS730P08000 AB DD C Screw(38)
4 LSTPP0016QSZZ AC DJ C Stopper
5 PCLC-0023QSZZ AS EQ B SPF paper feed clutch SPF
6 NPLYZ0033QSZZ AD DJ C Coupling pulley(39P)
8 XHBS730P10000 AD DD C Screw(310)
9 GCAB-0074QST1 AH DX N D Front cabinet
10 MHNG-0021QSZZ AX FG C SPF hinge L SPF L
11 MHNG-0022QSZZ AX FG C SPF hinge R SPF R
12 XWVS740-05000 AA DD C Washer
13 NBRGC0018QSZZ AD DJ C Bearing
14 LSOU-0037QST1 BD GJ N C Base tray
15 PCUSS0022QSZ3 AW EQ C OC mat OC
16 PSHEZ0413QSZZ AD DJ C OC mat sheet R OC R
17 PSHEZ0077QSZ1 AE DJ C OC mat sheet F OC F
18 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
19 LPLTP0321QSZZ AE DS C Width detect sensor fixing plate
20 GCAB-0078QST1 AV FG N D Original tray lower cabinet TLPD TLPD
21 LSOU-0039QSZ1 AN EQ C Original tray S S
22 MLEVP0098QSZZ AC DJ C Original detect actuator
23 VHPGP1S73P+-18 AF DS B Photo sensor(GP1S73P)
24 CPWBF0160QSE1 AS EQ E SPF VR PWB SPF VR
25 NGERP0168QSZZ AD DJ C Pinion gear(36T)
26 NGERR0169QSZZ AE DS C Width detect rack gear TLPD TLPD
27 MSPRC0250QSZZ AC DJ C Tray lock spring
28 PTME-0271FCZZ AD DJ C Tray lock pawl
29 XEPS730P08X00 AA DD C Screw(38X)
30 MSPRP0315QSZZ AD DJ C Regulation plate spring
31 LSOU-0038QST2 AW FG N C Original tray TLPD TLPD
32 LSOU-0041QST1 AP EQ N C Middle tray TLPD TLPD
33 LPLTP0319QSN1 AG DX N C Regulation plate F TLPD F TLPD
34 LPLTP0320QSN1 AG DX N C Regulation plate R TLPD R TLPD
35 DHAI-0468QSZZ AH DX C Original tray harness
37 CCLEZ0020QS01 AK EB C SPF glass cleaner SFP
501 CSOU-0037RS53 CD UD N E Base tray unit(Include Block 4-501)
( 4-501 )
502 CSOU-0038RS53 CE UH N E Original tray unit
5
3 RSPF 1(RSPF Exteriors 1)
2 1
3
8
2
5 4
6
13
33 32
34
10 501
22 2 35
23 9 12
22 35 11
23 31
12
2 12
2
30 12
21 26 25
29 37
2 2
27
28 26 29
24 19 16
18 14
17
20 18
18
18 15
18 PRP03703
502
6
4 RSPF 2(RSPF Exteriors 2)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 CPWBF0139QSE1 BA FX E SPF interface PWB SPF
2 XHBS730P08000 AB DD C Screw(38)
3 DHAI-0448QSZZ AV FG C SPF interface harness SPF
4 LPLTM0111QSZZ AC DJ C Reinforce plate earth plate
6 PSPO-0023QSZZ AB DJ C Sound proof sponge
7 PSPO-0004QSZZ AB DJ C Delivery gate sound proof sponge
8 RCORF0026FCZZ AL EB C Core(TRC-16813)
9 MSPRD0342QSZZ AD DJ C Delivery gate spring
10 MLEVP0036QSZZ AD DJ C Delivery gate lever
11 MLEVF0093QSZZ AE DJ C Pressure release lever
12 XBBS730P05000 AA DD C Screw(35)
13 DHAI-0388QSPZ AE DS C Delivery sensor harness
14 MSPRD0211QSZZ AC DJ C Delivery sensor ACT spring ACT
15 VHPSG2481++-1 AE DS B Photo sensor(SG2481)
16 MLEVP0092QSZZ AC DJ C Delivery sensor ACT lever TLPD ACT TLPD
17 XRESP20-04000 AA DD C E type ring(E2) E
18 NROLP0011QSZZ AD DJ C Delivery follower roller
19 PSPO-0020QSZZ AB DJ C Delivery sponge LPD LPD
20 PSHEZ0285QSZZ AB DJ C Delivery follower sound proof sheet
21 NSFTZ0013QSP1 AF DJ C Delivery sub shaft
22 PSPO-0003QSZZ AC DJ C Sound proof sponge
23 LHLDZ0101QSZZ AE DS C Pressure release holder
24 MSPRD0305QSZZ AC DJ C Delivery sub spring
25 LPINS0327FCZZ AC DJ C SP pin(210) SP
27 XRESP50-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E5) E
28 NBRGM0501FCZZ AB DJ C Bearing
29 NSFTZ0009QSP1 AE DJ C Transport sub shaft
30 NROLP1517FCZZ AA DJ B Transport sub roller
31 MSPRP0306QSZZ AC DJ C Read front sub spring
32 LPLTM0316QSZZ AH DX C Base tray reinforce plate
33 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
34 MSPRC0307QSZ1 AC DJ C Read front follower earth spring
35 MSPRP0123QSZZ AD DJ C Transport sub spring
36 MSPRT0308QSZZ AC DJ C Delivery sub earth spring
37 PSHEZ0436QSZZ AD DJ C Read front sheet
38 PSHEZ0069QSZZ AE DJ C Base tray sheet
39 PSHEZ0439QSZ1 AD DJ C Delivery gate sheet
40 LPLTP0117QSZZ AM EG C Delivery gate
41 NBRGP0041GCZZ AD DJ C Bearing
42 PRNGP0090FCZ1 AB DJ C Resin E ring(E5) E
43 LSOU-0037QST1 BD GJ N C Base tray TLPD TLPD
44 PSHEZ0459QSZZ AC DJ C Delivery gate sheet lower
501 CSOU-0037RS53 CD UD N E Base tray unit(Include Block 3-501)
( 3-501
7
4 RSPF 2(RSPF Exteriors 2)
3 2 2
4
8 1
12
6
43 7 12
11
9 10
41
42
13
14
15 29
16 30
40 17 28
18 27
20 31
19
21 34
37 24
22 29 33
20 30
44 19 25
39
18 32
17 23 36 33
38 24
35
501 27 30
28 33 33
PRP03704
8
5 RSPF (RSPF Paper feeding section)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 GCAB-0076QST1 AN EG N D Open/close cabinet
2 NGERH0166QSZZ AC DJ C Paper feed shaft gear(20T)
3 PCLC-0316FCP1 AP EQ B Torque limiter
4 MLNKP0001QSZZ AD DJ C Pick up link TLPD TLPD
5 MSPRD0309QSZZ AC DJ C Pick up arm spring
6 NGERH0167QSZZ AD DJ C Paper feed drive gear(32T)
7 NBRGM0096FCZ1 AC DJ C Bearing
9 XRESP50-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E5) E
11 XPSSP20-07000 AA DD C Spring pin(2-7)
12 LPLTM0318QSZZ AC DJ C Paper feed earth plate
13 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
14 MSPRD0314QSZZ AD DJ C JAM release spring R TLPD JAMR TLPD
17 NBRGC0018QSZZ AD DJ C Bearing(8)
18 NPLYZ0033QSZZ AD DJ C Coupling pulley(39P)
19 PCLC-0023QSZZ AS EQ B SPF paper feed clutch SPF
20 MARMM0047QSZZ AE DJ C U-turn paper guide arm R U R
21 LSTPP0016QSZZ AC DJ C Resin E ring(E5) E
22 DHAI-0390QSZZ AC DJ C U-turn earth harness U
23 PGIDM0105QSZ1 AQ EQ C U-turn paper guide TLPD U TLPD
24 GCAB-0077QST1 AP EQ N D U-turn paper guide cabinet U
26 MSPRP0311QSZZ AC DJ C PS sub tension spring PS
27 PTME-0029QST1 AE DJ N C U-turn paper guide lock pawl TLPD U
TLPD
28 MSPRD0310QSZZ AC DJ C U-turn paper guide lock spring TLPD U
TLPD
29 NROLP1517FCZZ AA DJ B Transport sub roller
30 NSFTZ0009QSP1 AE DJ C Transport sub shaft
31 MARMP0046QSZZ AD DJ C U-turn paper guide arm F U F
32 PCOVP0094QSZZ AD DJ C Maintenance cover
34 CSFTB0073QS01 AF DS E Pick up roller shaft ASSY
35 MARMP0044QSZ1 AF DS C Pick up arm
36 LFRM-0069QSZ1 AQ EQ C Paper feed frame TLPD TLPD
37 NCPL-0049FCBZ AT EZ C 1way coupling 1way
38 NPLYZ0035QSZZ AD DJ C Paper feed roller pulley(16P)
40 NROLR1542FCZZ AH DX B Pick up roller
41 NPLYZ0034QSZZ AD DJ C Pick up roller pulley(16P)
42 NBLTT0033QSZZ AF DS B Drive belt
43 VHPGP1S73P+-18 AF DS B Photo sensor(GP1S73P)
44 DHAI-0469QSZZ AG DX C Paper feed unit harness
45 PSHEZ0444QSZZ AE DS C Pick up sheet
46 MLEVP0097QSZZ AC DJ C Original detect actuator
47 LSTPP0015QSZZ AC DJ C Stopper
48 MLEVP0096QSZZ AC DJ C Stopper release lever
49 MARMP0045QSZZ AC DJ C Stopper arm
50 MSPRD0313QSZZ AC DJ C JAM release spring F JAM F
51 PSHEZ0407QSZZ AB DJ C PS guide sheet PS
52 VHPSG2481++-1 AE DS B Photo sensor(SG2481)
53 LHLDZ0153QSZZ AC DJ N C SPF pick up sub holder SPF
54 PMLT-0095QSZZ AB DJ C Pick up arm cushion
501 CCAB-0077RS53 BP LP N E U-turn paper guide unit U
9
5 RSPF (RSPF Paper feeding section)
1
2
3
4
5 11 9
7
21
54 19
49 6 18 20 13
7
17
9
47 48 14
49 51 13
48 13
13 23
46
47 51 22
13
52 13
12
29
24
13
44 13 26
13
30 26 13
36 31
29
45 34 13 27
50 43
44
35 28
13 32
41
42
40 7
9
53 37 13
38
501
PRP03705
10
6 RSPF 1(RSPF Transport section 1)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 PGIDM0107QSZ1 AQ EQ C Paper feed guide
2 PSHEZ0452QSZZ AF DS C Front separator sheet
4 PSHEZ0423QSZZ AP EQ C Separator sheet
5 LPLTP0328QSZZ AC DJ C SPF separator plate SPF
6 MSPRC0321QSZ1 AB DJ C Pressure spring
7 PSHEZ0451QSZZ AC DJ C Sound proof sheet
9 LPLTM0327QSZZ AD DJ C Sound proof plate
11 XHBS730P08000 AB DD C Screw(38)
12 NROLR0096QSZZ AR EQ B Transport roller
13 NROLR0131QSZZ AP EQ B PS roller SPF PS SPF
14 NROLR0095QSZZ AR EQ B Read front roller
15 PSHEP0647QSZZ AD DJ N C White sheet AN2R AN2R
16 LPLTM0325QSZZ AH DX C Transport plate
17 MSPRC0063QSZZ AB DJ C Delivery paper guide spring
18 DHAI-0467QSZZ AP EQ C RSPF harness RSPF
19 RDTCT0006QSPZ AX FG B Paper feed in detect sensor
20 PTME-0030QSZZ AC DJ C Open/close lock pawl TLPD TLPD
21 MSPRC3356FCZZ AA DJ C Lock spring
22 NBRGM0501FCZZ AB DJ C Bearing
23 XRESP50-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E5) E
24 XPSSP20-09000 AA DD C Spring pin(2-9)
25 NPLYZ0019QSZZ AE DJ C PS pulley PS
26 PSHEP3029FCZZ AA DD C Flange sheet DUP2 DUP2
27 LHLDZ0102QSZ1 AC DJ C Tension holder F F
28 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
29 NKOM-0007QSZZ AC DJ C Tension roller
30 MLEVP0095QSZZ AD DJ C Book sensor actuator TLPD TLPD
32 VHPSG2481++-1 AE DS B Photo sensor(SG2481)
33 XEBS740P14000 AB DD C Screw(414)
34 MSPRC0153QSZZ AB DJ C Book sensor spring
35 XWVS740-05000 AA DD C Washer
36 LPLTP0434QSZZ AC DJ C Book sensor fixing plate B1A B1A
37 JKNBZ0009QSZZ AE DJ D JAM release knob(24P) JAM
38 NBLTT0036QSZZ AF DS B Belt(B79MXL4.0)
39 NBRGC0017QSZZ AC DJ C Bearing
40 MSPRD0316QSZZ AC DJ C Tension spring F F
41 LPLTP0324QSZZ AH DX C Revers gate plate
42 NROLR0097QSZZ AR EQ B Delivery paper roller
43 LPLTM0326QSZZ AM EG C Paper feed paper guide reinforce plate
44 PBRSS0008QSZ1 AH DX B Discharge brush
45 PGIDM0106QSZ1 AU EZ C Transport R paper guide R
46 PSHEZ0454QSZZ AB DJ C Paper feed paper guide cushion R R
47 PSHEZ0455QSZZ AD DJ C Paper feed paper guide sound proof cushion
48 MSPRC0360QSZZ AC DJ C Delivery paper guide spring R R
49 LX-WZ5002BCZZ AA DD C Poly slider(6.2-12-0.5)
11
6 RSPF 1(RSPF Transport section 1)
4
5
46
2 6
7
1
47
44 42
43 45 9
21
28
11
21
47 28 20
18
22
41 17
23 12
13
39
40
36 24
37 38
28 19
35 22
23 24
33 25 48
32 34 22
26 49
23
14
27 23
30 29
18 28
16 15
PRP03706
12
7 RSPF 2(RSPF Transport section 2)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 RMOTS0043QSPZ BG GT B SPF motor TLPD SPF TLPD
2 DHAI-0467QSZZ AP EQ C RSPF harness RSPF
3 PTPE-0018QSZZ AC DJ C Motor earth tape
4 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
6 RPLU-0015QSP1 AR EQ B Pressure release solenoid
7 PSPO-0022QSZZ AB DJ C Sound proof sponge
8 XRESP40-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E4) E
9 PSHEZ0414QSZZ AB DJ C Flange sheet
10 NBLTT0034QSZZ AF DS B Belt(48S2M244)
11 NGERH0170QSZZ AD DJ C Gear(48T/43P)
12 NBRGM0501FCZZ AB DJ C Bearing
13 NGERH0116QSZ1 AD DJ C Gear(48T/25P)
14 XEPS730P08X00 AA DD C Screw(38X)
15 NGERH0117QSZZ AK DX C Gear(48T)
16 XPSSP20-09000 AA DD C Spring pin(2-9)
17 NPLYZ0019QSZZ AE DJ C PS pulley PS
18 NBLTT0035QSZZ AE DS B Belt(B86MXL4.0)
19 PSHEP3029FCZZ AA DD C Flange sheet(DUP2)
20 XRESP50-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E5) E
21 MSPRP0312QSZZ AD DJ C U-turn earth spring U
22 XHBS730P08000 AB DD C Screw(38)
23 NBRGC0017QSZZ AC DJ C Bearing
24 NPLYZ0018QSZZ AE DJ C PS coupling pulley PS
25 PCLC-0032QSZZ AX FG N B PS clutch SPF PS SPF
26 NKOM-0007QSZZ AC DJ C Tension roller
27 MSPRT0317QSZZ AC DJ C Tension spring R R
28 LHLDZ0103QSZZ AC DJ C Tension holder R R
29 LPLTM0322QSZZ AF DS C Transport earth plate
31 LPLTM0323QSZ1 AG DX C Motor fixing plate
32 XBBS730P05000 AA DD C Screw(35)
34 MSPRC0418QSZZ AC DJ N C PS Brake spring AN2R PS AN2R
35 XWHS760-08115 AA DD C Washer(M6)
37 PTPE-0069QSZZ AC DJ N C SPF motor cooling sheet SPF
38 LX-WZ5002BCZZ AA DD C Poly slider(6.2-12-0.5)
13
7 RSPF 2(RSPF Transport section 2)
2
1
4
4
4
3
31
7 6
37
8
9
10
11
32
32 20
12 19
14
18
13 17
15 8
16
4
21 25
4 22
34 24
38 19
12
20
35
23
20 26
12 28
14
29
27
PRP03707
14
8 (Operation panel unit)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 PSHEZ0646QSPZ AE DJ N C PWB protect sheet
2 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
3 DHAI-0503QSPZ AE DS C KEY PWB harness KEY
4 CPWBX0211QSF2 BR LX N E OPU PWB OPU
5 MSPRP3009FCZZ AD DJ C LCD earth plate LCD
6 LHLDZ0119QSZZ AK EB C LCD holder B LCD B
7 VVL81HB1T03-A BV RB B LCD module LCD
8 LHLDZ0118QSZZ AL EB C LCD holder LCD
9 PSHEZ5764FCZZ AC DJ C Touch panel sheet
10 HPNLH0264FCZZ BF GN B Touch panel 8.1 8.1
11 CPNLC0072QS05 AX FG N C Operation panel B EX B EX
15 CPNLC0070QS02 AR EQ N C Operation panel 8.1 EX A8.1EX
18 JBTN-0071QSA1 AR EQ N C Mode key
19 CBTN-0290FC01 AK DX C Ten key
20 CBTN-0292FC03 AR EQ N C Interrupt key
21 PFILW0319FCZZ AK EB C Copy key ring
22 PLNS-0105FCZZ AC DJ B Popwer supply key lens
23 CBTN-0291FC02 AG DX C CA key EX CA EX
24 JBTN-0284FCAZ AR EQ C Copy key
25 CPWBF0234QSE2 AX FG N E Key PWB KEY
26 LDAIU0037QSZZ AS EZ N C Operation base plate A A
27 QCNW-0249FCPZ AZ FQ C LCD-FFC P2 LCD-FFC P2
28 LDAIU0038QSZZ AQ EQ N C Operation base plate B B
29 XEBS740P10000 AA DD C Screw(410)
30 LPLTP0499QSZZ AD DJ N C Operation panel side plate left
31 LPLTP0498QSZZ AE DJ N C Operation panel side plate right
CPNLH0073QS01 AZ FQ N C Key sheet [English for FAX]
CPNLH0073QS02 AP EQ N C Key sheet [English]
32
CPNLH0073QS03 AP EQ N C Key sheet [French for FAX]
CPNLH0073QS04 AS EQ N C Key sheet [French]
(Unit)
901 CPNLC0070RS51 CC UB N E Operation panel unit
15
8 (Operation panel unit)
2
901
28 1
2
2
3 2
29 2 2
4
2 2
2 29 2
2 2
2
2
25 2
5
6
20
24 22 7
2 2 2
23 27
30 2
19
21 18 8
2 2
9
10
2
15 9
26 2
31
11
32
PRP03708
16
9 (Frame section)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 LPLTM0163QSZZ AK EB C Left reinforce plate lower
2 XHBS730P08000 AB DD C Screw(38)
3 LPLTM0232QSZ2 AU EQ C Frame reinforce plate R R
4 CFRM-0043QS03 AX FQ D Corner frame RL RL
5 XEBS740P10000 AA DD C Screw(310)
7 PSHEZ0507QSZZ AA DJ C Pulley flange sheet N N
9 NPLYZ0036QSZZ AD DJ C DUP idle pulley TLPD DUP TLPD
11 LDAI-0023QSTE BG GT N D Base plate
14 LHLDW1757FCPZ AC DJ C Wire saddle(HL-18-0)
15 XHBS740P10000 AA DD C Screw(410)
16 LPLTM0333QSZ2 AX FG C Frame reinforce plate F F
18 XRESP40-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E4) E
19 NBLTT0026QSZZ AF DS B DUP drive belt DUP
20 LPLTM0165QSZ3 AS EZ C Front reinforce plate
21 PCOVP0110QSZ1 AE DJ D Interlock cover
22 LPLTM0166QSZZ AC DJ C Front support adjusting plate
23 CFRM-0044QS03 BB FX C Right frame unit
24 LPLTM0251QSZ1 AE DS C PS earth plate PS
25 NSFTZ0048QSPZ AF DS C Cassette collar shaft
26 NKOM-0005QSZZ AC DJ C Cassette guide collar
27 XBPS730P08KS0 AB DD C Screw(38KS)
28 XHBS730P06000 AC DD C Screw(36)
40 PSHEZ0333QSZZ AC DJ C PS front sheet PS
41 PSHEZ0325QSZZ AB DJ C Frame lower sheet
42 CPLTM0342QS01 AH DX C DU motor fixing plate ASSY DU
43 NGERH0174QSZ1 AD DJ C DUP drive gear TLPD DUP TLPD
45 NBLTT0038QSZZ AF DS B DUP drive belt TL DUP TL
46 LPLTM0332QSZZ AE DJ C Fusing unit earth plate
47 LPLTM0495QSZZ AE DJ N C Power supply switch fixing plate And2 Ref And2
Ref
48 XEBS740P12000 AA DD C Screw(412)
55 PMLT-0091QSZ1 AD DJ C Right frame cushion A A
56 PGSK-0044QSPZ AH DX C OP holder cushion OP
61 NPLYZ0015QSZZ AC DJ C Pulley(S2M20T)
62 MSPRC1315FCZ1 AD DJ C Manual paper feed clutch spring A A
63 NGERH0066QSZZ AD DJ C 1 way gear(17T) 1
64 PSHEZ0432QSZZ AA DJ C PS front sheet 2 PS 2
65 LBSHC0009QSPZ AC DJ N C Edge bush(CE-012 L15)
66 LHLDW1009ACZZ AA DD C Clamp(UAMS-05S-2)
67 PSHEZ0448QSZZ AA DJ C Optical bottom sheet And And
68 NFANP0020QSPZ AP EQ N B Fan motor ANR2 ANR2
69 XBPS730P30KS0 AC DD C Screw(330KS)
71 MSPRT0147QSZZ AC DJ C Stopper arm spring
72 LX-BZ0852FCZZ AC DD C Step screw
17
9 (Frame section)
15
4 56
2
2
3
1
2
5
15
68
2
5 42
15
14 7 2
69 16 20 67
5 67 43
15 18 2
64 45
47 27 22
15 5
26 55
25 46
15 5 5 2
15 23 5
48
40
64 2
5 66 11 71
24 21
28 15 2 7
65 41
19
7 9 72
18
18 7 72
61
62
63
PRP03709
18
F (Lamp unit)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 PREFL0004QSZZ AP EQ B Reflector
! 2 RLMPU0012QSZZ BG GT B Lamp
3 LHLDZ0047QSZ3 AW FG C Base
4 MSLI-0138FCZZ AC DJ C Slider
5 PCUSU0203FCZZ AE DS C Protection cushion
6 MSPRP0145QSZZ AF DS C Mirror spring
7 PMIR-0009QSZZ AS EQ B 1st mirror 1st
8 DUNTK0034QSP3 BK HC N E Inverter unit
9 DHAI-0200QSZZ AS EZ C CL harness CL
10 LFIX-0009QSZZ AF DS D Harness fixing
11 PCUSS0033QSZZ AC DJ C Mirror cushion
12 XEBS830P06000 AB DD C Screw(36)
14 LPLTM4715FCZ1 AF DS C Wire fixing plate F F
15 TCAUH0933FCZZ AB DD D High temperature caution label
19
F (Lamp unit)
4
2
5
4
14
6
12
7
12 9
15
8 10
12
12
11
5 6
4 PRP03710
14 12 12 12
20
G 1(Optical frame 1)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 PWIR-0006QSPZ AZ FQ C MB wire F MB F
2 CDAIU0012QS15 BG GT C Optical base plate
3 NPLYZ0016QSZZ AF DS C Pulley
4 NPLYZ0006QSZ1 AD DJ C L pulley L
5 XRESP40-05000 AA DD C E type ring(E4) E
6 PWIR-0005QSP1 AZ FQ C MB wire R MB R
7 CMIR-0008QS36 BB GD E 2/3 mirror unit 2/3
9 XBPS740P06K00 AA DD C Screw(46K)
10 LHLDZ0056QSZZ AC DJ C Wire holder
11 LX-BZ0004QSPZ AB DD C Screw
12 LRALM0007QSZ1 AG DS C MB-B rail R MB-B R
13 LRALM0006QSZZ AG DS C MB-B rail F MB-B F
14 XBPS730P05K00 AA DD C Screw(35K)
15 RMOTP0027QSZZ BG GT B Mirror motor
16 MSPRC0040QSZZ AB DJ C MB drive spring MB
17 CPLTM0084QS02 AK DX C Mirror motor fixing plate
18 PGUMS0002QSPZ AL EB C Protection rubber
19 XBPS740P16KS0 AB DD C Screw(416KS)
20 PGUMS0004QSZZ AA DJ C Table glass cushion
21 XRESP50-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E5) E
22 NBRGP0012QSZZ AC DJ C Winder bearing R R
23 NPLYZ0004QSZZ AG DX C Winder drive shaft pulley
24 NPLYZ0031QSZZ AL EB C Winder pulley
25 LX-BZ0049FCPZ AB DD C Screw
26 XPSSJ30-12000 AB DD C Spring pin(3-12)
27 NSFTZ0028QSZ1 AS EQ C Winder drive shaft
28 LX-BZ0324FCPZ AA DD C Screw
29 NBLTT0002QSZZ AH DX B Winder drive belt
30 NGERH0027QSZZ AH DX C Mirror motor idle gear
31 LX-WZ0119FCP1 AC DD C Washer
32 XRESP70-08000 AA DD C E type ring(E7) E
33 NBRGP0011QSZZ AC DJ C Winder bearing F F
34 LX-BZ0082QSPZ AA DD C Screw(38)
35 PGIDM0108QST1 AG DX N C Hinge guide L L
36 XHBS730P08000 AB DD C Screw(38)
37 PGIDM0109QST1 AG DX N C Hinge guide R R
38 LPLTM0497QSZZ AG DS N C Panel support plate LN LN
39 LANGF0021QSZZ AF DS C Panel reinforce angle R R
40 XHBS740P10000 AA DD C Screw(410)
21
G 1(Optical frame 1)
3
4
34 36
5 34
6 36
9
7 10 35
5 37
3 4 11
16
9 19
14
10 2 18
15
11 20
36 17
13 12 18 19
40 21
1 22
11 32
38 30 29 28
31
23
26
11 24
36 25
28 27
33
32
39 24
40 PRP03711
25
22
H 2(Optical frame 2)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 PCOVP0075QSZZ AE DS D Harness cover
2 XNES730-24000 AA DD C Nut(M3)
3 VHPGP2D03//-18 AZ FX B Photo sensor(GP2D03)
4 DHAI-0347QSPZ AN EQ C Optical sensor harness
5 LHLDW1009ACZZ AA DD C Clamp(UAMS-05S-2)
6 XBBS830P08000 AA DD C Screw(38)
7 CPWBF0083QSE5 AU EZ E Sensor PWB
8 CDAIU0012QS15 BG GT C Optical base plate
9 PGUMS0004QSZZ AA DJ C Table glass cushion
10 XHBS730P06000 AC DD C Screw(36)
11 VHPGP2D032/-18 BA FX B Photo sensor(GP2D032)
12 XBPS730P08X00 AA DD C Screw(38X)
13 LPLTP0230QSZZ AF DS C Open/close sensor fixing plate
14 VHPGP1S73P+-18 AF DS B Photo sensor(GP1S73P)
15 MSPRD0232QSZZ AB DJ C Return spring
16 MLEVP0077QSZZ AC DJ C Open/Close actuator
17 LCRA-0002QSZZ AC DJ C Mini clamp
18 TLABH0461QSZZ AG DS D Clean caution label (U.S.A,Canada)
19 LHLDZ0104QSZZ AD DJ C CL lead holder CL
20 PSHEZ0218QSZZ AC DJ C Edge protect sheet A A
21 PSHEZ0217QSZZ AC DJ C CCD harness protect sheet B CCD B
22 PSHEZ0448QSZZ AA DJ C Optical bottom sheet And And
24 PCASZ0010QSZZ AL EB C Dark box
26 RCORF0002QSZZ AE DS C Core(HF57SH35*1)
28 CLNS-0003RS55 BP LE E Lens unit
29 LX-BZ0004QSPZ AB DD C Screw
30 DHAI-0345QSZZ AG DX C CCD harness CCD
31 PSHEZ0108QSZZ AC DJ C Optical base plate bottom sheet A A
32 PSHEZ0219QSZZ AC DJ C Edge protect sheet B B
33 LX-BZ0031GCPZ AB DD C Screw
34 PSHEZ0254QSZZ AC DJ C Optical bottom sheet C
38 PSHEZ0273QSZZ AB DJ C CCD harness protect sheet A CCD A
39 PGSK-0008QSPZ AF DS C Gasket
41 PMLT-0094QSZZ AC DJ C Cushion ORG ORG
43 PSHEZ0420QSZZ AC DJ C OP harness protect sheet OP
44 PTPE-0051QSZZ AC DJ C OP harness fixing tape OP
45 PSHEZ0426QSZZ AB DJ C OP harness protect sheet B OP B
46 PTPE-0063QSZZ AD DJ C OP harness fixing tape A2 OP A2
48 DHAI-0610QSP1 BF GN N C Operation PWB FFC FFC
49 PTPE-0050QSZZ AA DJ C Core fixing tape
23
H 2(Optical frame 2)
1 16
14
4 6 15
7 12
10
5 9 11 12
8 48
2 13 45
20 43
10
3 9
9 31 21
34 32 5 19 24
41
9 10
5 39
17 18
9 39
33 26
29
30
9
49
22
38
46 22 22
22 28
44 PRP03712
48
24
I (Middle frame section)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 DUNTK0616RSZZ BV NU E LSU unit(Include No.101) LSU
2 XEPS730P14X00 AB DD C Screw(314X)
5 MARMP0025QSZZ AD DJ C Separator pawl arm
6 XEBS730P10000 AC DD C Screw(310)
7 CHAI-0356RS51 AL EB C MC harness MC
8 CHAI-0603RS51 AN EQ N C GRID-MCFB harness GRID-MCFB
9 LHLDZ0057QSZ1 AH DX C High voltage terminal holder B B
10 DHAI-0506QSPZ AQ EQ C LSU interface harness LSU
11 MSPRD0190QSZ2 AD DJ C High voltage terminal holder spring saw teeth L
L
12 MSPRD0191QSZ2 AD DJ C High voltage terminal holder spring grid L
L
13 MSPRD0192QSZ2 AD DJ C High voltage terminal holder spring case L
L
15 LX-BZ0020QSPZ AB DD C Step screw
16 LPLTM0424QSZZ AD DJ C CRUM connector fixing plate CRUM
18 XRESP50-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E5) E
19 PCLC-0030QSZZ AQ EQ N B PS clutch PS
27 XBBS730P05000 AA DD C Screw(35)
28 LHLDZ0085QSZZ AE DJ C TR terminal holder TR
29 LPLTM0248QSZ1 AD DJ C TR terminal plate TR
30 NROLR0089QSZ3 AY FQ N C PS transport roller Ref PS Ref
31 NBRGC0018QSZZ AD DJ C Bearing
32 PCOVP0062QSZZ AD DJ D ILSW cover ILSW
33 LSTPP0010QSZZ AD DJ C Right door stopper
34 MSPRC0220QSZZ AB DJ C Stopper spring
35 MLEVP0071QSZZ AD DJ C ILSW lever ILSW
36 CSW-M0007RS56 AP EQ B Interlock switch
37 LHLDZ0065QSZ1 AF DS C ILSW holder ILSW
39 MSPRT0221QSZZ AB DJ C ILSW spring ILSW
40 JKNBZ0006QSZZ AD DJ D PS knob PS
41 XBPS730P08KS0 AB DD C Screw(38KS)
42 XBPSC30P06ES0 AA DD C Screw(36ES)
43 LFRM-0037QSZ6 BA GD D Middle frame
44 XRESP60-08000 AA DD C E type ring(E6) E
47 RMOTD0023QSZZ AZ FX B Toner motor
48 MSPRC0024QSZ1 AC DJ C Hopper spring
49 NCPL-0011QSZZ AC DJ C Hopper coupling
50 RPLU-0024QSZZ AM EG B Pawl solenoid
51 MSPRC1318FCZ1 AA DJ C Manual paper feed spring B B
52 LPINS0025QSZZ AC DJ C TN guide pin A TN A
53 XEBS740P10000 AA DD C Screw(410)
54 XEBS730P06000 AA DD C Screw(36)
55 DHAI-0354QSPZ AG DS C TC harness TC
63 MSPRC0271QSZZ AC DJ C Earth spring
64 XEPS723P12000 AA DD C Screw(312)
65 PSHEZ0394QSZ1 AB DJ N C Solenoid sound proof sheet
66 QSW-B0017QSZZ AF DS B Tray detect switch
67
CPLTM0160RS59 BH HC N E Drive unit [MX-M260]
CPLTM0160RS60 BH HC N E Drive unit [MX-M310]
70 PSPAZ0041QSZZ AA DJ C Solenoid spacer
74 PMLT-0120QSZ1 AL EB C Fusing cushion A [MX-M310] A
75 PMLT-0116QSZZ AE DJ C Fan cover cushion L L
76 PMLT-0117QSZZ AD DJ C Fan cover cushion R R
77 PCOVP0108QSZ1 AK DX N C Fan cover
78 XHBS730P08000 AB DD C Screw
79 XHBS730P20000 AB DD C LSU cooling fan screw(320) LSU
80 NFANP0081FCZZ BA FX B LSU cooling fan LSU
81 LPLTM0392QSZZ AK DX C Fan plate
82 QCNCM1000FCPZ AC DJ C Interface connector(BU03P-TR-PH)
83 LBNDJ0071FCZZ AC DJ C Cable band(RSG-100)
84 PTPE-0062QSZZ AD DJ C Fan plate tape FAN
85 XEBS740P12000 AA DD C Screw(412)
86 XEPS730P14X00 AB DD C Screw(314X)
87 PCOVP0109QSZZ AN EG C LSU cover LSU
88 PMLT-0118QSZ1 AC DJ C LSU cover cushion L LSU L
89 PMLT-0148QSZZ AB DJ N C LSU cover cushion R LSU R
91 PCOVP0143QSZZ AH DX N D Process air intake duct cover
92 PDUC-0010QSZZ AH DX N D Process air intake duct
93 DHAI-0609QSPZ AK DX N C AN2R PS fan harness AN2R PS
101 RMOTN0055QSPZ BL HG B Polygon motor(for LSU)
25
I (Middle frame section)
89
88 86
87 83
86
85
82
79 78
82
80 77
81
2 84 78
76
10
1 79 6 75
2 84 80 MX-M310 6
101 2
91 7
6 47
48 A
8 49 9 6
2 16
6
52 53 A
11
92 70 5 42
53 15 12 6
13
53 63
50 18
51 19 6
93
65
53
28
37 67
66 31 55
74 44 29
35 54
28
44 32
36 31
27 6 29 54
6
39 64
40 33
41 43 30 34
PRP03713
26
J 550 (550 cassette unit)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 LPLTP0159QSZZ AD DJ C Cassette rear edge plate
2 LHLDW1226FCZZ AB DJ C Turn fastener
3 LPLTM0179QSZ1 AR EQ C Rotation plate
4 PSHEZ0274QSZZ AC DJ C Rotation plate sheet
5 GCASP0006QSZZ BA FX D 550 cassette 550
6 PGIDM0070QSZ1 AM EG D Guide F F
8 LPLTM0181QSZ1 AB DJ C Side plate guide F F
9 PGIDM0071QSZZ AL EB D Guide R R
10 LX-BZ1144FCPZ AA DD C Screw
11 NGERH0193FCZZ AB DD C UC manual paper feed gear UC
12 MSPRC2631FCZZ AC DJ C Fusing pressure spring
13 MLEVP0755FCZ1 AE DJ C Side plate F lever F
14 LX-BZ0833FCPZ AC DD C Screw
15 PSHEZ0244QSZ2 AC DJ C Cassette sheet
16 XRESP70-08000 AA DD C E type ring(E7) E
17 NGERH0108QSZZ AD DJ C Lift gear(22T)
18 MSPRC0354QSZZ AC DJ C Lift gear spring
19 NSFTZ0047QSZ1 AK EB N C Lift shaft
20 LPLTM0180QSZ1 AE DS C Lift plate
21 NBRGP0041GCZZ AD DJ C Bearing
22 XEBS740P10000 AA DD C Screw(410)
23 GCOV-0282FCZZ AH DX D Cassette handle cover P2 P2
24 XBPS740P08KS0 AB DD C Screw(48KS)
25 PSHEZ5948FCZZ AD DJ C Cassette handle sheet P2 P2
27 LPLTM0277QSZZ AC DJ C Side plate guide R R
28 JHNDP0013QSZZ AT EZ N C Cassette panel AN2R AN2R
29 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
(Unit)
901 CCASP0006RS59 BH GX N E 550 cassette unit 550
27
J 550 (550 cassette unit)
1 2
8
6
9
10
4
11 11
3 13
12
22 14 27
22 5
15
16
17
22 18
22 21 19
23
20 24
29
25
28
PRP03714
28
K (Paper feed section)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 XEBS730P10000 AC DD C Screw(410)
2 CPWBF0081QSE2 AP EQ E Cassette sensor PWB
3 MLEVP0064QSZZ AD DJ C Paper detect actuator
4 MLEVP0063QSZ1 AD DJ C Upper limit detect actuator
5 MLEVP0056QSZZ AC DJ C P-IN actuator P-IN
6 MSPRD0201QSZZ AC DJ C Paper feed in actuator spring
7 PCOVP0064QSZZ AD DJ D Solenoid cover
8 RPLU-0026QSZ1 AR EQ B Paper feed solenoid
9 MARMP0026QSZZ AD DJ C Solenoid arm
10 NROLR0133QSZZ AM EG A Pick up roller
11 MARMP0019QSZZ AD DJ C Pick up arm F F
13 NGERH0990FCZZ AB DJ C Gear(16T)
14 NROLR0132QSZ1 AR EQ C Paper feed roller AND2 AND2
15 MARMP0021QSZZ AD DJ C Pick up arm R R
16 LPIN-0026MCZZ AA DD C Spring pin(2-8)
17 NGERH0107QSZZ AD DJ C Paper feed gear(20T)
18 MSPRD0389QSZZ AC DJ C Pick up roller pressure spring
19 NBRGC0100FCZ1 AC DJ C Bearing 6 6
20 NGERH0097QSZZ AF DS C 2nd joint gear 2nd
21 DHAI-0350QSPZ AG DX C Cassette sensor harness
22 QSW-B0017QSZZ AF DS B Tray detect switch
23 NGERH0156QSZZ AD DJ C Paper feed clutch gear(42T)
24 MSPRC0209QSZ1 AC DJ C Solenoid spring
25 XRESP40-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E4) E
27 XRESP50-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E5) E
28 PCLC-0024QSZZ AX FG B Paper feed clutch(42T)
29 NSFTZ0080QSZ1 AG DS N C Paper feed roller shaft
30 VHPSG2481++-1 AE DS B Photo sensor(SG2481)
31 DHAI-0399QSPZ AF DS C Manual paper feed empty harness
36 PSHEZ0391QSZ1 AC DJ N C Paper feed solenoid sound proof A A
37 PSHEZ0392QSZ1 AB DJ N C Paper feed solenoid sound proof B B
38 PSHEZ0393QSZ1 AA DJ N C Paper feed solenoid sound proof C C
29
K (Paper feed section)
15
1 10
13 19
2 7 18
8
17
38 16
21
3 14
9 11
20
36
4
24 29
5
6
25
22
28
27 23
19
37 31
30
PRP03715
30
L (Paper transfer section)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 XEBS740P12000 AA DD C Screw(412)
2 PCOVP0053QSZ6 AK EB N D Middle frame cover
3 MSPRD0194QSZ1 AD DJ C PS earth spring LP PS LP
4 MSPRC0291QSZZ AC DJ C PS pressure spring PS
5 NSFTZ0065QSZ1 AD DJ N C PS sub shaft PS
6 NKOM-0006QSZZ AC DJ C PS collar(13.5) PS
7 PSHEZ0133QSZZ AD DJ C Paper feed sheet
8 XEBS740P10000 AA DD C Screw(410)
9 PGIDM0067QST1 AP EQ N C Base plate paper feed guide
10 MSPRD0233QSZ1 AC DJ C MF actuator spring MF
11 MLEVP0023QSZZ AE DS C MF actuator MF
12 MLEVP0044QSZZ AE DS C MF actuator 2 MF 2
13 LPLTP0348QSZZ AC DJ C Separator plate
14 MSPRC0301QSZZ AD DJ C Pressure plate spring
15 PFTA-0019QSZZ AE DS D Pressure plate cover
16 XEBS730P10000 AC DD C Screw(310)
17 PSHEZ0242QSZ1 AH DX C Pressure plate sheet
18 LRALP0008QSZ2 AN EG C Base plate rail R R
19 VHPGP1S73P+-18 AF DS B Photo sensor(GP1S73P)
20 DHAI-0398QSPZ AE DS C Manual paper feed P-IN harness P-IN
21 MSPRD0202QSZZ AB DJ C Manual paper feed P-IN actuator spring P-IN
22 MLEVP0057QSZZ AC DJ C Manual paper feed P-IN actuator P-IN
23 PSHEZ0515QSZZ AG DX A Separator sheet
24 LPLTP0409QSZZ AC DJ C Separator plate AND2 AND2
25 PCOVP0088QSZ1 AD DJ D Plate cover
26 MSPRC0270QSZZ AB DJ C Separator plate spring
27 NKOM-0005QSZZ AC DJ C Cassette guide collar
28 NSFTZ0048QSPZ AF DS C Cassette collar shaft
29 XBPS730P08KS0 AB DD C Screw(38KS)
33 PSHEZ0301QSZZ AC DJ C Rail R side sheet F R F
34 PSHEZ0302QSZZ AC DJ C Rail R side sheet R R R
36 PSHEZ0463QSZZ AD DJ C Front separator sheet
37 PSPO-0026QSZZ AA DJ C MF ACT cushion MF ACT
38 LHLDZ0094QSZZ AC DJ C PS pressure holder PS
39 MSPRC0292QSZZ AC DJ C PS follower connect spring PS
40 MSPRD0287QSZZ AC DJ C Paper feed sub roller spring
41 NROLP0087QSZZ AD DJ C Paper feed sub roller
42 NSFTZ0101QSZZ AC DJ N C Paper feed sub roller shaft
43 PSHEZ0314QSZ2 AF DS C Toner protect sheet N N
44 LBRC-0012QSZZ AD DJ C Manual paper feed sub collar bracket
45 NKOM-0011QSZZ AC DJ C Manual paper feed sub collar
46 NSFTZ0101QSZZ AC DJ N C Paper feed sub roller shaft
47 MSPRD0340QSZZ AC DJ C Manual paper feed sub roller spring SP
48 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
51 LPLTM0396QSZ1 AD DJ C Separator guide plate
52 LX-WZ0064FCZZ AA DD C Push nut(M3)
53 PGIDM0186QSZZ AK DX N D Cover guide
54 LPLTM6022FCZZ AC DJ C M4 plate N M4 N
504 CPLTP0409RS51 AN EG C Separation plate unit
31
L (Paper transfer section)
48 53 48
48
1
1 36 1
43 7
1 2
54 1 3
5
4 11
38
4 39 10
6 48 17
44 12
38
9 14 37
5 45
46 47 13
15 20
16 19
34
33
21
8
22
18 41
42
40
28
27 23
29 8 52 51 24 26
504 25
40
16
PRP03716
32
M (Side door unit)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 MLEVP0058QSTZ AD DJ N C Lock lever
3 XRESP40-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E4) E
4 LBSHZ0303FCZZ AC DJ C M bushing C M C
5 NGERH0074QSZZ AD DJ C DUP roller drive gear DUP
6 LPINS0133FCZZ AA DD C Pin(210)
7 PTME-0020QSZ1 AC DJ C Lock pawl
8 MSPRD0222QSZZ AC DJ C Lock pawl spring
9 MARMP0043QSZZ AC DJ C Lock pawl arm
10 NSFTZ0055QSZ3 AH DX N C Lock pawl shaft
11 XRESP30-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E3) E
12 NROLP0036QSZZ AP EQ C DUP transport roller DUP
13 XPSSJ20-07000 AA DD C Spring pin(2-7)
14 MSPRT0279QSZ1 AC DJ C DUP follower spring DUP
15 NROLP1122FCZZ AF DS C PS upper roller PS
16 LFRM-0040QSZ3 AS EQ N D Right door inner
17 MSPRC0349QSZZ AD DJ C High voltage spring B B
18 MSPRC0348QSZZ AD DJ C High voltage spring A A
19 LPLTM0102QSZZ AD DJ C DUP roller earth plate DUP
20 LHLDZ0084QSZ1 AE DS C TR terminal interface holder TR
21 XEBS730P06000 AA DD C Screw(36)
22 MSPRC0296QSZZ AF DS C TR pressure spring R TR R
23 MSPRC0295QSZZ AF DS C TR pressure spring F TR F
24 XHBS730P10000 AD DD C Screw(310)
25 XHBS730P16000 AA DD C Screw(316)
27 XEBS730P10000 AC DD C Screw(310)
28 LPLTM0090QSZ1 AE DJ C Inner reinforce plate F F
29 LPLTM0091QSZ1 AE DJ C Inner reinforce plate R R
30 MSPRD0205QSZZ AE DS C TC ground spring TC
31 LRALP0004QSZ3 AH DX C Right door rail
32 LPLTM0363QSZZ AF DS C Rail reinforce plate
33 CHLDZ0150RS52 BE GN N A TC unit TC
34 PSHEZ0307QSZ1 AB DJ C Right door sheet
36 PSHEZ0431QSZ1 AF DS C Right door DUP sheet DUP
38 LX-BZ0084QSPZ AB DD C Screw
39 NGERH0243QSZZ AD DJ N C TC gear(20T) TC
40 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
41 MSPRC0289QSZZ AB DJ C TC roller spring R REF R REF
42 MSPRC0280QSZZ AC DJ C TC roller spring F F
43 LSUPP0003QSZ1 AD DJ C Right door roller rib
44 PCLR-0014QSZ1 AD DJ N C TC roller collar A2R TC A2R
46 PGIDH0093QSZ3 AN EG C TR front paper guide TR
49 LHLDZ0150QSZ1 AK DX N C Transfer holder And2 Ref And2 Ref
50 LPLTM0365QSZZ AD DJ C TR electrode plate TR
51 NROLR0159QSZ1 AY FQ N C Transfer roller AN3 AN3
52 NBRGP0023QSZZ AD DJ C Roller bearing
54 LPLTM0245QSZ2 AG DX N C TR reinforce plate TR
55 LX-BZ1181FCZZ AB DD C Screw(36K)
56 LPLTM0512QSZZ AG DX N C Separate discharge sheet
57 LPLTM0247QSZZ AC DJ C Separate electrode plate
58 PMLT-0044QSZZ AA DJ C TR cushion TR
59 PSEL-0163QSZ1 AH DX N C Transfer cleaner pad
60 LHLDZ0151QSZZ AF DS N C Separate holder And2 Ref And2 Ref
61 PRNGF0107FCZ1 AC DJ C Star ring
(Unit)
901 CDOR-0002RS62 BF GN N E Side door unit(Without No.33) (No.33 )
33
M (Side door unit)
1
12 3
4
27 25
43 38
16
14
15 23
4
13 14
15 30
3
28
27
40
5 38 24
11 25 36 31 24
34
6 34
7 22 34
11
36 34
19
29
10 17 24 32
9
8 20 31 40
42
7
24 44
52
32 51
21
18 61
61
41 58
52 61 B
39 61
21 61
61 A 21
44
55 60 61 56
B A
54 57 58
21 55
46
21 33
49 59
50
PRP03717
34
N (Multi manual paper feed tray unit)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
3 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
4 LSOU-0024QSTE AS EQ N D Manual paper feed tray 1 upper 1
5 PTME-0271FCZZ AD DJ C Tray lock pawl
6 MSPRC0250QSZZ AC DJ C Tray lock spring
7 NGERR0140QSZZ AD DJ C Width detect rack
8 XEPS730P06X00 AA DD C Screw(36X)
9 NGERP1385FCZZ AF DS C Width detect pinion
10 LHLDZ0066QSZZ AD DJ C Harness holder
11 LSOU-0026QSTC AP EQ N D Manual paper feed tray 2 upper 2
12 QSW-B0017QSZZ AF DS B Tray detect switch
13 DHAI-0359QSZZ AP EQ C Manual paper feed unit harness
14 MSPRP2830FCZZ AA DJ C Width detect plate spring
15 LPLTP0234QSZZ AE DS C Width detect plate
16 MLEVP0035QSE2 AC DJ C Original detect actuator
17 CPWBF0106QSE4 AP EQ E Manual paper feed VR PWB VR
19 VHPGP1S73P+-18 AF DS B Photo sensor(GP1S73P)
20 LSOU-0027QSTC N D Manual paper feed tray 2 lower 2
22 XEBS730P06000 AA DD C Screw(36)
(Unit)
901 CSOU-0024RS65 BF GN N E Manual paper feed tray unit
35
N (Multi manual paper feed tray unit)
3
4
3
3
5
6
3 11
10
12
6 12
5 3
9
3 7
7 8
A 14 16
8 19
15 A
16
13
17 22
3 19
3 20
22
22 22
PRP03718
36
O (Multi manual paper feed unit)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 PCOVP0107QSTF AL EB N D Multi frame cover N1 N1
2 XEBS730P10000 AC DD C Screw(310)
3 PSHEZ0099QSZZ AC DJ C Protect sheet S S
4 NROLR0922FCZ2 AR ZZ C Manual paper feed roller -
5 NGERH0223QSZZ AC DJ C Gear(20T)
6 XPSSJ20-07000 AA DD C Spring pin(2-7)
7 NGERH0061QSZZ AD DJ C Gear(24T)
8 MARMP0009QSZ1 AF DS C Roller arm
9 MSPRT0351QSZZ AC DJ C Roller arm spring
10 NROLR1267FCZ1 AH DX C Pick up roller
11 NSFTZ0096QSZ1 AF DS N C Roller shaft F N F N
12 XRESP40-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E4) E
13 LBSHZ0303FCZZ AC DJ C M bushing C M C
14 LBOSZ0150QSZZ AE DS C Cam boss A2 N A2 N
15 MSPRC1315FCZ1 AD DJ C Manual paper feed clutch spring A A
16 PPIPP0109FCZ1 AC DJ C Manual paper feed clutch sleeve A pipe A
17 LBOSZ0199QSZZ AE DS N C Cam boss A1 A1
18 MARMP0041QSZZ AE DS C Cam transmission arm
19 MARMP0006QSZZ AD DJ C Fulcrum arm
20 MSPRD0347QSZZ AD DJ C Stopper arm spring
21 MCAMP0003QSZZ AD DJ C Drive cam
22 MSPRC1316FCZ1 AE DS C Manual paper feed clutch spring B B
23 PPIPP0014QSZZ AC DJ C Cam clutch sleeve
25 NSFTZ0017QSP1 AD DJ N C Manual paper feed cum shaft
26 NGERH0972FCZZ AB DJ C Gear(27T)
27 CPLTM0345QS01 AG DX C Paper feed connect plate TLPD TLPD
29 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
30 PTME-0178FCZ1 AC DJ C Manual paper feed pawl A A
31 MSPRC2175FCZZ AA DJ C Pawl A spring A
32 RPLU-0028QSZZ AM EG B Multi field solenoid
33 MSPRC1318FCZ1 AA DJ C Manual paper feed spring B B
34 PTME-0179FCZZ AC DD C Manual paper feed pawl B B
35 XBBS730P10000 AA DD C Screw(310)
36 MARMP0027QSZ1 AE DJ C Manual paper feed tray arm
37 LFRM-0048QSTH AS EQ N D Multi frame
38 MARMP0008QSZZ AH DX C Stopper arm
39 LPLTP0056QSZ3 AD DJ C Stopper plate
40 XEPS730P06X00 AA DD C Screw(36X)
41 XEBS730P10000 AC DD C Screw(310)
42 PSHEZ0241QSZZ AB DJ C Manual paper feed protection sheet
43 LBNDJ0013FCZ1 AE DJ C Band
44 NSFTZ0090QSZZ AG DX C Roller shaft R N R N
45 MSPRD0302QSZZ AC DJ C Manual paper feed coupling spring
46 MSPRD0329QSZZ AC DJ C Revers ACT spring ACT
47 NCPL-0012QSZZ AD DJ C Manual paper feed coupling
48 CPWBF0083QSE5 AU EZ E Sensor PWB
49 DHAI-0360QSPZ AE DJ C DUP 2 sensor harness DUP2
50 MLEVP0104QSZZ AD DJ C Revers lever
51 LBSHZ0006QSZZ AC DJ C M bushing 2 M 2
52 LSTPP0011QSZZ AC DJ C Resin E type ring E
53 LX-WZ0011QSZZ AB DD C Poly slider(5-12-0.5)
(Unit)
901 CFRM-0048RS55 BE GN N E Multi manual paper feed unit(Without No.36,40,41,43)
(No.36,40,41,43 )
37
O (Multi manual paper feed unit)
901 12
17
51 43
52 15
14 6 29 13
2 13
1 11 12
2 16
52 44 29
53 29
45
19 26 27
47 22
9 21 12
3 17
29 20 23
4 8
50 46 18 32
48 30
33
42 25 31
5
6
41 34
10
49
7
40
35
37 36 38
41
36 39
40 PRP03719
38
P DV (DV unit)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 LHLDZ0142QSZZ AD DJ N C Filter holder
2 PFILD0313FCZZ AG DX A TN filter TN
3 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
4 PGIDM0158QSZZ AH DX N C Cartridge guide top
5 PSEL-0162QSZZ AE DJ A DV blade DV
6 LX-BZ1066FCZZ AC DD C Blue screw(36)
7 PGIDM0159QSZZ AM EG N C Cartridge guide bottom
9 PMLT-0142QSZZ AC DJ C Pipe cover cushion N N
10 PSEL-0964FCZ1 AA DJ C Cover upper seal
11 PMLT-0141QSZZ AC DJ C DV guide cushion N DV N
12 PMLT-0147QSZZ AB DJ N C DV side cushion R DV R
13 LDAIU0033QSZZ AC DJ C DV block R DV R
14 NROLP0150QSZZ AS EQ C MX roller L MX L
15 NROLP0149QSZZ AS EQ C MX roller R MX R
16 PMLT-0146QSZZ AB DJ N C DV side cushion F DV F
17 XEBS730P06000 AA DD C Screw(36)
18 LHLDZ0132QSZ1 AC DJ C Scraper holder
19 PBOX-0025QSZZ AM EG N C DV BOX DV
20 DHAI-0566QSPZ AQ EQ C Toner sensor harness
21 XRESP40-06000 AA DD C E ring(E4) E
22 NBRGY0769FCZ2 AQ EB C MG bearing MG
23 NPLYZ0041QSZZ AC DJ N C MX pulley MX
24 LPLTM0194QSZZ AC DJ C DV box fixing plate
25 XBPS730P06KS0 AB DD C Screw(36KS)
26 NPLYZ0040QSZZ AC DJ N C MG pulley MG
27 NBLTH0494FCZZ AD DJ B DV belt DV
28 PSHEZ0652QSZZ AA DJ N A DV side sheet F DV F
29 XBBS730P04000 AA DD C Screw(34)
30 PSHEZ0651QSZZ AA DJ N A DV side sheet R DV R
31 XRESP50-06000 AA DD C E ring(E5) E
32 XEBS730P10000 AC DD C Screw(310)
33 NBRGC0020QSZZ AH DX C DMX bearing(F6/14) DMX
34 NGERH1653FCZZ AC DJ C DMX gear(24T) DMX
35 LX-BZ1143FCPZ AD DJ C Screw
36 LHLDZ0128QSZZ AC DJ C DV holder F DV F
37 MSPRD0395QSZZ AC DJ C Bias spring
38 LHLDZ0129QSZZ AC DJ C MG holder MG
39 PCOVP0122QSZZ AF DS N D DV cover F DV F
41 PMLT-0002YSZ1 AC DJ C DV TH cushion DVTH
42 PSHEP0632QSZZ AB DJ C Doctor cover seal
43 LPLTM0002YSZ4 AR EQ C Doctor reinforce plate
44 LPLTM0477QSZZ AK EB N C DV doctor DV
45 XBPBZ30P03000 AB DD C Screw(33)
46 PCOVP0121QSZZ AE DJ C Doctor cover
47 XBBBZ30P06000 AC DD C Screw(36)
48 RDTCM0021QSZZ AY FQ N B ATC sensor ATC
49 XUBUZ30P08000 AA DD C Screw(38)
(Unit)
901 DUNT-0777RSZZ BN HZ N E DV unit DV
39
P DV (DV unit)
3
1
2
3 4
3
5 6
7
9
6 A
B 20
10 11 12 3
13 21 C
22
21
23
22
14 25
24 26
3
15
16 27
19 22
17
28
18
A
31 29
32 24
33 36 42
41
34 44
30 45
32 35
34 43
37
33
C 38 45
32
32 B 46
45
47
39 48
3
3
3 3
49 901
PRP03720
40
Q (Process unit)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
2 PCAPH0022QSZZ AC DJ N D Toner pipe cap
3 NSRW-0002QSZZ AE DS C Transport pipe screw
4 LPLTM0241QSZZ AF DS C Process reinforce plate
5 MLEVP0065QSZZ AE DS C Separator pawl lever
7 NCPL-0003QSZ1 AC DJ C Screw coupling
10 PSEL-0071QSZZ AF DS A Seal R R
11 PSEL-0070QSZZ AF DS A Seal F F
12 PSHT-0014QSZZ AC DJ C Toner pipe shutter
13 PPIPP0017QSZZ AE DS N C Toner pipe
14 MSPRC0045QSZ1 AC DJ C Toner pipe spring
15 PSPAZ0696FCZZ AC DJ C Pipe cap spacer
16 NGERH0036QSZZ AC DJ C Transport screw gear(30T)
17 PCOVP0132QSZZ AF DS N D Drum cover
18 NGERH0039QSZZ AE DS C Transport pipe gear(14T)
19 LFIX-0015QSZZ AE DJ C Drum fixing plate B B
20 NGERH0037QSZZ AC DJ C Idle gear(26T)
21 NGERH0038QSZZ AC DJ C Transport pipe gear(15T)
22 NSFTZ0020QSZ1 AL DS C Transport screw
23 NBRGP0299FCPZ AD DJ C DV bearing DV
24 PMLT-0018QSZ1 AC DJ C Transport screw cushion
25 PTME-0021QSZZ AK DX C Separator pawl
26 LX-WZ0329FCPZ AB DD C Washer
27 LX-RZ0001QSZZ AB DD C Star ring
28 MSPRT0214QSZZ AB DJ C Lever spring
29 LX-BZ0064QSZZ AA DD C Screw(38)
30 MSPRC0213QSZZ AB DJ C Separator pawl spring
32 CCLEZ0011QS32 BD GN N A Cleaning brade
33 XEBS730P10000 AC DD C Screw(310)
34 PSHEZ0329QSZZ AC DJ C Toner stir sheet
35 PTPE-0026QSZ1 AA DJ C Screw tape
36 LHLDZ0090QSZZ AC DJ C Star ring holder
37 LX-BZ0406FCPZ AA DD C Screw(34)
38 PRNGF0106FCZ2 AC DJ A Star ring N2 N2
39 PRNGP0081FCZ1 AB DJ C Resin E ring(E4) E
44 PSHEZ0557QSZZ AC DJ C DR brake sheet DR
46 XBBS730P06000 AC DD C Screw(36)
502 CTME-0021RS51 AK EB A Separator pawl unit
(Unit)
901 CFRM-0049RS5N BG GT N E Process unit(Without No.19,44)
(No.19,44 )
41
Q (Process unit)
29
29
32
1 4
29 1
2 28
1 7
5 46
36
37
12 36
38 37 38
3 10 23
30
15 36
13 37 502 22
36 30
26 25
14 38 27 35
26
37
33 27 44
16 38 25
39 502
17
33 11 35
18 34
24
901 21
20
19 PRP03721
42
R 1(Fusing unit 1)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
2 MLEVP0100QSZZ AE DS C Pressure release lever F TL F TL
3 MLEVP0101QSZZ AE DS C Pressure release lever R TL R TL
8 RTHM-0050FCZZ AN EG B Thermostat TL TL
10 DHAI-0367QSPZ AE DJ C DUP sensor harness DUP
11 LHLDW0086QSZZ AB DJ C Harness ring
12 RH-HX0001QSLB AT EZ B Thermistor TL TL
13 LPLTM0338QSZ1 AC DJ C Fusing earth plate UR UR
14 VHPGP1SQ73P-18 AF DS B Photo sensor(GP1SQ73P)
15 XEBS730P06000 AA DD C Screw(36)
18 LSTPF0172FCZZ AA DD C Roller stopper
! 19 RLMPU0040QSPZ BA FX N B Heater lamp (120V)
22 LHLDZ0139QSZZ AD DJ N C Lamp fixing plate
23 LFRM-0098QSZZ AV FG N D Fusing upper frame(TL)
24 MSPRC0323QSZZ AC DJ C Fusing unit earth spring
25 LPLTM0337QSZ1 AC DJ C Fusing earth plate UF UF
27 NROLM0129QSZZ BB FX A Heat roller(TL)
28 NGERH0171QSZZ AR EQ A Fusing gear(TL)(38T)
29 NBRGP0025QSZZ AN EQ A Upper HR bearing(TL) HR
30 LPLTM0343QSZZ AB DJ C Gear key plate(TL)
31 CPLTM0336QS02 AR EQ A Fusing cleaner plate
32 MSPRT0257QSZ1 AC DJ C Upper pawl spring
33 MSPRD0322QSZZ AC DJ C Fusing ACT return spring ACT
34 MLEVP0099QSZ1 AF DS C Fusing rear paper detect lever
35 PGIDM0113QSZZ AT EZ C Fusing rear upper guide PG
36 PTME-0282FCZ2 AH DX A Upper separate pawl
37 LX-WZ0006QSZZ AC DD C Washer
38 PTME-0024QSZ2 AN EQ A Upper separate pawl LPD
39 LX-BZ0086QSPZ AD DJ C Fusing unit fixing screw
41 LX-BZ1195FCZZ AC DD C Screw(M3)
42 LSTYM0004QSZZ AK DX N C Fusing upper frame stay And3 And3
43 LPLTM0510QSZZ AD DJ N C Earth joint plate
44 LX-BZ1181FCZZ AB DD C Screw(36)
45 LPLTM0473QSZZ AE DJ N C Fusing earth plate And3 And3
46 LX-BZ1126FCPZ AB DD C Thermister screw
47 XHPS730P04000 AB DD C Screw(34)
48 XWHS730-05080 AA DD C Washer
50 PCOVP0148QSZZ AK DX N C Thermostat cover
(Unit)
901 DUNTW0782RSZZ BW RJ N E Fusing unit(Include Block 23) (120V) ( 23 )
43
R 1(Fusing unit 1)
44
44
44 3
43
45
10
22
2 41 14
15 41 13 A
15 50 B 11
44
B 15
15
47
44 B 48
8
47 47
48
8 48 15
47
48
42
41
A
23 12
28
24 46
46 29
25
15
19 30
44
27
31 34
32
29 33 35
32
39
32
36
18 37
38
37
38
39
901
36
PRP03722
44
S 2(Fusing unit 2)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 NBRGY0022QSZZ AL EB A Fusing pressure bearing FU
2 NROLR0156QSZZ BF GN N A Fusing roller
3 MSPRC0324QSZZ AC DJ C Fusing pressure spring(TL)
5 LPLTM0341QSZ1 AC DJ C Fusing earth plate(DR)
8 PGIDH0140QSZZ AY FQ A Fusing front guide
9 LPLTM0340QSZZ AC DJ C Fusing earth plate(DF)
11 MSPRD0328QSZ1 AC DJ C Lower pawl spring R(TL) R
12 PTME-0041QSZZ AG DS N A Lower separate pawl
13 TCAUH0017QSZ1 AC DJ D High temperature caution label
14 XBPSN30P08KS0 AA DD C Screw(38KS)
15 MSPRD0327QSZ1 AC DJ C Lower pawl spring F(TL) F
17 MSPRD0326QSZZ AC DJ C Fusing rear lower guide spring
18 PGIDM0115QSZZ AS EQ C Fusing rear lower guide
19 TLABH0289QSZZ AA DJ D Fusing green label
20 MLEVF0111QSZZ AD DJ C Pressure lever F(AND2) F
21 MLEVF0112QSZZ AD DJ C Pressure lever R(AND2) R
22 TLABH0685QSZZ AD DJ D High temperature caution label
24 XWHS740-08090 AA DD C Washer
(Unit)
901 DUNTW0782RSZZ BW RJ N E Fusing unit(Include Block 22) (120V) ( 22 )
45
S 2(Fusing unit 2)
1
21
3
24
3
11
20 14 12
9
12 11
13
17
24 12
15
12
14
18 22
15
19
PRP03723
46
T (Drive unit)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 XBPS740P08ES0 AB DD C Screw(48ES)
2 RMOTP0069QSPZ BA FX N B Main motor
3 CPLTM0160QS02 AU FG C Main drive plate
4 MSPRC0200QSZ1 AC DJ C Ratchet spring
5 NGERH0234QSZZ AF DS C Ratchet gear(49T)
6 NGERH0090QSZ1 AF DS C Fusing drive gear(19T)
7 NGERH0084QSZZ AK DX C Gear(94/21T)
8 XRESP70-08000 AA DD C E type ring(E7) E
9 NGERH0192QSZZ AD DJ C Gear(46/19T)
NGERH0086QSZZ AD DJ C Gear(39/21T) [MX-M260]
10
NGERH0190QSZZ AC DJ C Gear(39/19T) [MX-M310]
NGERH0087QSZZ AE DJ C Gear(30/21T) [MX-M260]
11
NGERH0189QSZZ AD DJ C Gear(30/21T) [MX-M310]
12 NGERH0010QSZZ AD DJ C Gear(28T)
13 NGERH0092QSZZ AD DJ C Gear(30/16T)
14 NGERH0093QSZZ AD DJ C Gear(28/16T)
15 XBPS730P06KS0 AB DD C Screw(36KS)
16 NGERH0095QSZZ AE DJ C Gear
17 NGERH0191QSZZ AC DJ C MG gear MG
18 NGERH0186QSZZ AH DX C N gear(58/21T) N
19 NGERH0096QSZZ AE DJ C Gear(37/25T)
20 CPLTM0161QS02 AP EQ C Sub drive plate
21 MSPRC0262QSZ1 AC DJ C MG spring MG
22 NCPL-0009QSZZ AC DJ C MG coupling MG
23 NGERH0091QSZZ AE DJ C Coupling gear(34T)
24 CGERH0204RS51 AX FQ C Drum coup gear
25 DHAI-0602QSPZ AE DS N C AN2R main motor harness AN2R
26 LX-WZ0012QSZZ AB DD C Poly slider AND2 AND2
27 XRESP50-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E5) E
28 LX-WZ0476FCZZ AC DD C Poly slider
29 LX-WZ0407FCZZ AB DD C Poly slider
(Unit)
CPLTM0160RS59 BH HC N E Drive unit [MX-M260]
901
CPLTM0160RS60 BH HC N E Drive unit [MX-M310]
47
T (Drive unit)
4
7 28
5 25
1
6
29
8
9
10 2
3
13
15
11
15
12 14
17 12 18
21
22
20 16
23 12
15
24 19 PRP03724
26
27
48
U 1(1st delivery paper unit 1)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 NSFTZ0042QSZ1 AE DS N C Delivery sub roller shaft
3 NROLP0049QSZZ AC DJ C Delivery sub roller
4 NROLP0111QSZZ AD DJ C Delivery sub roller(Large) ( )
6 PBRSR0019QSZZ AK DX B Discharger brush LP LP
7 NROLR0114QSZZ AR EZ C Delivery roller C C
8 NBRGY2122SCZZ AB DD C Transport roller bearing
9 LPLTM0195QSZ2 AC DJ C Delivery earth plate A A
10 NBRGM0501FCZZ AB DJ C Bearing
11 XRESP50-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E5) E
12 LHLDZ0058QSZ3 AQ EQ C Delivery roller holder
13 LPLTP0185QSZ2 AL EB C Delivery change gate
14 MSPRD0224QSZZ AB DJ C Delivery actuator spring
15 MLEVP0055QSZ1 AC DJ C Delivery actuator
16 MSPRT0197QSZ1 AC DJ N C Delivery sub spring
17 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
18 CPWBF0222QSE3 AK EB N E Sensor PWB
21 CSFTZ0023QS04 AE DS N C Shifter shaft
22 XRESP40-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E4) E
23 LFRM-0038QSZ5 AZ FX C Delivery frame
24 NROLR0051QSZ1 AL EB C DUP delivery roller DUP
25 LBSHZ0303FCZZ AC DJ C M bushing C M C
26 PGIDM0165QSZ1 AR EQ N C Delivery upper paper guide
27 NROLP1122FCZZ AF DS C PS upper roller PS
28 MSPRT0229GCAZ AC DJ C FU spring R FU R
29 XHBS740P10000 AA DD C Screw(410)
35 LX-BZ0780FCPZ AC DD C Screw
36 PSHEZ0650QSZZ AB DJ N C Delivery hole sheet B B
38 PSHEZ0655QSZZ AD DJ N C Delivery fan connector sheet
39 PFILZ0017QSZ1 AP EQ A Ozone filter
41 LPLTM0509QSZZ AC DJ N C OF fixing plate OF
42 NFANP0020QSPZ AP EQ N B Fan motor ANR2 ANR2
(Unit)
901 CFRM-0038RS74 BP LP N E 1st delivery unit(Include Block 28 Without No.29,35) 1st
49
U 1(1st delivery paper unit 1)
6
1 3 13
4
3
4 11
3
4 10
3
36
7
14
16 15
9 12 17 23 38
29 39
11 18
8 16 42
10 17
41
26
36
22 24
21 39
17
25 17
22 42
41
35
27
28
27
17 28
PRP03725
50
V 2(1st delivery paper unit 2)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
4 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
13 MSPRD0216QSZZ AD DJ C Shifter earth spring
14 MSPRT0217QSZ1 AC DJ C Gate return spring
15 LBRC-0002QSZ1 AC DJ C Gate bracket
16 LBSHZ0303FCZZ AC DJ C M bushing C M C
17 NBRGY2122SCZZ AB DD C Transport roller bearing
18 NBRGC0019QSZZ AD DJ C Bearing(6)
19 XPSSJ30-08000 AA DD C Spring pin(3-8)
20 NBLTT0024QSZZ AG DS B Drive belt 240 240
21 NGERH0080QSZZ AE DJ C Delivery drive gear(25/31T)
22 NGERH0082QSZZ AD DJ C DUP delivery gear(20/31T) DUP
23 MSPRD0198QSZZ AC DJ C Delivery earth spring B B
24 NGERH0113QSZZ AC DJ C Idle gear B(29T) B
25 NGERH0114QSZZ AC DJ C Idle gear C(29T) C
26 MSPRD0196QSZZ AC DJ C Delivery earth spring A A
27 NGERH0155QSZZ AD DJ C Gear(31/39T)
28 RPLU-0027QSZZ AU EZ B Change gate solenoid
29 CBRC-0004QS03 AF DS C DUP motor fixing bracket DUP
30 RMOTS0070QSPZ BD GJ N B DUP motor DUP
31 XHBS730P08000 AB DD C Screw(38)
33 XWHS730-05070 AA DD C Washer
35 PSHEZ0316QSZZ AD DJ C Delivery motor sheet
36 PRDAZ0002QSZZ AD DJ C Delivery motor radiation plate
(Unit)
901 CFRM-0038RS74 BP LP N E 1st delivery unit(Include Block 27) 1st
51
V 2(1st delivery paper unit 2)
24
25
13
14 16
15 17
20
18 26
28 19
22
33 21
4 23
27
30 35
36 29
31
4 PRP03726
52
W (PWB section)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
CPWBX0136QS3L CB TX N E IMC PWB [MX-M260] IMC
1
CPWBX0136QS3M CB TX N E IMC PWB [MX-M310] IMC
2 XBBS730P08000 AA DD C Screw(38)
3 PSPAB0039QSZZ AG DJ C Spacer
4 CPWBF0235QSE1 BB GD N E Option interface PWB
5 XBBS830P08000 AA DD C Screw(38)
7 LHLDZ0062QSZ2 AT EZ C MCU PWB fixing plate MCU
8 LX-BZ0090QSPZ AE DD C Hexagon screw 6
9 LHLDW0086QSZZ AB DJ C Harness ring LPD LPD
CPWBX0233QS31 CD UD N E MCU PWB [MX-M260] MCU
10
CPWBX0233QS32 CD UD N E MCU PWB [MX-M310] MCU
11 XBPS730P06KS0 AB DD C Screw(36KS)
12 LHLDZ0071QSZZ AG DX C Mother board holder
13 CPWBN0137QSE1 AZ FX E Mother board
14 XHBS730P08000 AB DD C Screw(38)
15 LX-BZ0082QSPZ AA DD C Screw(38)
16 LHLDZ0070QSZ3 AW FG N C OP PWB holder OP
17 XHBS730P08000 AB DD C Screw(38)
18 XEBS740P10000 AA DD C Screw(410)
19 XBPS730P08KS0 AB DD C Screw(38KS)
20 PSHEZ0269QSZZ AC DJ C CCD harness sheet CCD
22 DHAI-0345QSZZ AG DX C CCD harness CCD
29 CPWBX0202RS55 BZ TR N E PCL PWB PCL
30 PCAPH0018QSZZ AD DJ D 15P protect cap 15P
32 PCAPH0017QSZZ AC DJ D 9P protect cap 9P
37 DHAI-0200QSZZ AS EZ C CL harness CL
38 DHAI-0347QSPZ AN EQ C Optical sensor harness
39 DHAI-0506QSPZ AQ EQ C LSU interface harness LSU
41 DHAI-0350QSPZ AG DX N C Cassette sensor PWB harness
42 DHAI-0610QSP1 BF GN N C Operation PWB FFC FFC
43 DHAI-0381QSPZ AH DX C Fusing interface harness
55 TLABH0533QSZZ AB DJ D USB label AND USB AND
56 TLABH0534QSZZ AB DJ D NIC label AND NIC AND
70 RDTCH0161FCP1 AV FG B Temperature humidity sensor
72 DHAI-0595QSPZ AE DS N C Temperature humidity sensor harness
73 LSUPM0002QSZZ AE DJ C Support post
74 RCORF0046FCZZ AH DX C Core
VHI29L1607DQS BB GD N B MCU ROM [MX-M260] MCU ROM
82
VHI29L1607EQS BB GD N B MCU ROM [MX-M310] MCU ROM
83 VHI29L12856QS BH HC N B PCL PRGDIMM PCL PRGDIMM
84 VHI29L32077QS AZ FQ N B PCL BOTDIMMJ PCL BOTDIMMJ
85 LBNDJ0013FCZ1 AE DJ C Band
86 PSPAN0025QSZZ AE DS C Spacer
87 LX-BZ0024QSZZ AA DD C Screw
53
W (PWB section)
3 30
87 32 8
1
3 2 14
3 4
86
42 2
2
3 22 14
87 5
43 37 38 14
87 7
85 20
9 5
2
2 14
2
82
5
17 70 2
16 2 10
17 12
17
74 2 14
41 72 13
11
73 2 14
11 15 2 14
11 73
18 55
83 11 56
29
84
39
19
19 PRP03727
54
X (Rear frame section)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 XBPSN40P06K00 AA DD C Screw(46K)
4 XHBS730P06000 AC DD C Screw(36)
5 LPLTM0162QSZ1 AC DJ C Drive earth plate
6 LPLTM0252QSZZ AD DJ C Paper feed earth plate LP LP
8 DHAI-0378QSPZ AC DJ C Cassette earth harness
9 XHBS730P08000 AB DD C Screw(38)
10 XEBS740P30000 AC DD C Screw(430)
11 PGIDM0184QSZ1 AH DX N C Harness guide
12 XEBS740P30000 AC DD C Screw(430)
13 CDAIU0024RS57 AZ FQ E 1st lift up unit 1st
15 LPLTM0249QSZZ AC DJ C 2nd earth plate 2nd
! 19 QACCD7713QCPZ AT EZ B AC cord AC
20 QSW-C9295QCPZ AL EB B Power supply switch(AJ8W200BF)
! 28 RDENC0052QSPZ BZ TF N E Low voltage power supply unit
! 29 RDENU0058QSPZ BN LE N E High voltage power supply unit
30 LHLDW1057FCZZ AB DD C Wire saddle(LWS-3S)
32 LFIX-0016FCZZ AD DJ C AC cord fixing AC
33 XEBS740P30000 AC DD C Screw(430)
34 XEBS740P12000 AA DD C Screw(412)
35 XWHS740-08100 AA DD C Washer
36 XWSS740-10000 AA DD C Washer
37 LPLTM0349QSZZ AS EQ C Power supply fixing plate
38 NFANP0020QSPZ AP EQ N B P/S fan motor PS
39 XBPS730P30KS0 AC DD C Screw(330KS)
42 XBPS730P08KS0 AB DD C Screw(38KS)
45 LPLTM0369QSZZ AG DS C Delivery support angle
46 XHBS740P10000 AA DD C Screw(410)
47 LSUPP0133FCPZ AC DJ C PWB supporter
49 RCORF0031QSPZ AK DX C Core
50 LBNDJ0013FCZ1 AE DJ C Band
53 LHLDW1154FCZZ AC DJ C Wire saddle(LWS5S2W)
55
X (Rear frame section)
45
50
49
46 1
5
4
15 6
9 8 50 49 39
9 38
42 42 42
10
11 47
34 42 29
42 42
47 20
12 42 28
13 42
30 53
32
35
36
34
53 9
37
33 36 35
9 PRP03728
19
56
Y 2nd (2nd exteriors)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 GCAB-0030QSTB AL EB N D Left cabinet
2 XEBS740P12000 AA DD C Screw(412)
3 LPLTM0504QSZZ AC DJ C 2nd joint plate S 2nd S
5 GCOVA0025QSTC AR EQ N D 2nd rear cover 2nd
8 LPLTM0236QSZZ AG DX C 2nd reinforce plate R 2nd R
10 PCOVP0063QSTB AC DJ N D Front cover
12 NSFTZ0048QSPZ AF DS C Cassette collar shaft
13 NKOM-0005QSZZ AC DJ C Cassette guide collar
14 XBPS730P08KS0 AB DD C Screw(38KS)
15 GLEGG0064FCZZ AC DJ D Rubber foot
16 LPLTM0237QSZZ AH DX C 2nd reinforce plate F 2nd F
22 PSHEZ0325QSZZ AB DJ C Frame lower sheet
23 LX-BZ0083QSPZ AB DD C Screw
57
Y 2nd (2nd exteriors)
2
2
1 3 2
2
23 5
2
3 23 23 2
16
2 14 3
2 13 12
22
15
15
8 2
2 10
3 2
PRP03729 2
58
Z 2nd 550 (2nd 550 cassette unit)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 LPLTP0159QSZZ AD DJ C Cassette rear edge plate
2 LHLDW1226FCZZ AB DJ C Turn fastener
3 LPLTM0179QSZ1 AR EQ C Rotation plate
4 PSHEZ0274QSZZ AC DJ C Rotation plate sheet
5 GCASP0005QSZ4 BA GD D 550 cassette 550
6 PGIDM0070QSZ1 AM EG C Guide F F
8 LPLTM0181QSZ1 AB DJ C Side plate guide F F
9 PGIDM0071QSZZ AL EB C Guide R R
10 LX-BZ1144FCPZ AA DD C Screw
11 NGERH0193FCZZ AB DD C UC manual paper feed gear UC
12 MSPRC2631FCZZ AC DJ C Fusing pressure spring
13 MLEVP0755FCZ1 AE DJ C Side plate F lever F
14 LX-BZ0833FCPZ AC DD C Screw
15 CSHEZ0244QS02 AE DJ C 2nd cassette sheet ASSY 2nd
16 XRESP70-08000 AA DD C E type ring(E7) E
17 NGERH0108QSZZ AD DJ C Lift gear(22T)
18 MSPRC0354QSZZ AC DJ C Lift gear spring
19 NSFTZ0047QSZ1 AK EB N C Lift shaft
20 LPLTM0180QSZ1 AE DS C Lift plate
21 NBRGP0041GCZZ AD DJ C Bearing
22 XEBS740P10000 AA DD C Screw(410)
23 JHNDP0012QSZZ AU EZ N C 2nd cassette panel AN2R 2nd AN2R
24 XBPS740P08KS0 AB DD C Screw(48KS)
25 GCOV-0282FCZZ AH DX D Cassette handle cover P2 P2
26 PSHEZ5948FCZZ AD DJ C Cassette handle sheet P2 P2
27 LPLTM0277QSZZ AC DJ C Side plate guide R R
28 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
(Unit)
901 CCASP0005RS59 BK HC N E 2nd 550 cassette unit 2nd 550
59
Z 2nd 550 (2nd 550 cassette unit)
1 2
8
6
9
10
4
11 11
3 13
12
22 14 27
22 5
15
16
17
18
22
23 22 21 19
20 24
28
26
25
PRP03730
60
[ 2nd (2nd paper feed section)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
2 PCOVP0070QSZZ AD DJ D Sensor cover
4 CPWBF0095QSE3 AP EQ E 2nd cassette sensor PWB 2nd
5 MLEVP0063QSZ1 AD DJ C Upper limit detect actuator
6 MLEVP0064QSZZ AD DJ C Paper detect actuator
7 MLEVP0062QSZZ AC DJ C P-IN detect actuator
8 PCOVP0064QSZZ AD DJ D Solenoid cover
9 RPLU-0026QSZ1 AR EQ B Paper feed solenoid
10 MARMP0026QSZZ AD DJ C Solenoid arm
11 MSPRC0209QSZ1 AC DJ C Solenoid spring
13 NSFTZ0102QSZZ AH DX N C 2nd paper feed roller shaft 2nd
14 QSW-B0017QSZZ AF DS B Tray detect switch
17 DHAI-0397QSPZ AD DJ C Cassette detect interface harness
18 NBRGC0100FCZ1 AC DJ C Bearing 6 6
19 MSPRD0389QSZZ AC DJ C Pick up roller pressure spring
20 MARMP0021QSZZ AD DJ C Pick up arm R R
21 NGERH0107QSZZ AD DJ C Paper feed gear(20T)
22 LPIN-0026MCZZ AA DD C Spring pin(2-8)
23 NROLR0132QSZ1 AR EQ C Paper feed roller AND2 AND2
24 MARMP0019QSZZ AD DJ C Pick up arm F F
26 NGERH0990FCZZ AB DJ C Gear(16T)
27 NROLR0133QSZZ AM EG A Pick up roller
29 DHAI-0394QSPZ AD DJ C Door open/close detect harness
30 MSPRD0204QSZZ AC DJ C Paper feed in detect actuator spring
31 DHAI-0473QSP1 AG DX N C Cassette sensor PWB harness
61
[ 2nd (2nd paper feed section)
8
a 14
2
17
33 2 10
9 a
13
4
5 11
7
31
30
6
19
27
18
14
26 20
21
22
29 23
24 PRP03731
62
\ 2nd (2nd paper transfer section)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 MSPRC0378QSZ1 AB DJ C Lock spring
2 MLOKZ0001QSZZ AC DJ C Paper guide lock
3 XEPS730P08X00 AA DD C Screw(38X)
4 PGIDM0068QSZ1 AP EG C Transport paper guide
5 MARMP0015QSZZ AD DJ C 2nd door arm 2nd
6 NSFTZ0054QSZ1 AD DJ N C Transport paper guide shaft
7 NROLP1060FCZZ AF DS C U-turn roller U
8 MSPRP0345QSZ1 AD DJ C Transport paper guide spring
9 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
11 XEBS730P10000 AC DD C Screw(310)
12 PCOVP0089QSZZ AD DJ D Plate cover
13 LPLTP0409QSZZ AC DJ C Separator plate AND2 AND2
14 PSHEZ0515QSZZ AG DX A Separator sheet
15 NROLR0130QSZZ AL EB C Transport roller
16 MSPRC0270QSZZ AB DJ C Separator plate spring
17 NBRGZ0503FCZZ AC DJ C Bearing
18 LSTPP0011QSZZ AC DJ C Resin E type ring E
19 LRALP0009QSZ2 AP EQ C Cassette rail R R
20 XBPS730P08KS0 AB DD C Screw(38KS)
21 NKOM-0005QSZZ AC DJ C Cassette guide collar
22 NSFTZ0048QSPZ AF DS C Cassette collar shaft
23 PGIDM0074QSZZ AK DX C 2nd U-turn guide 2ndU
24 XEBS740P12000 AA DD C Screw(412)
25 PSHEZ0301QSZZ AC DJ C Rail R side sheet F R F
26 PSHEZ0302QSZZ AC DJ C Rail R side sheet R R R
27 MSPRD0287QSZZ AC DJ C Paper feed sub roller spring
28 NROLP0087QSZZ AD DJ C Paper feed sub roller
29 NSFTZ0101QSZZ AC DJ N C Paper feed sub roller shaft
30 PSHEZ0356QSZ1 AE DS C Plate cover sheet
31 PSHEZ0347QSZ1 AC DJ C 2nd rail R sheet 2nd R
33 LPLTM0396QSZ1 AD DJ C Separator guide plate
34 PSPAZ0055QSZZ AA DJ C Plate cover spacer
35 LX-WZ0064FCZZ AA DD C Push nut(M3)
503 CPLTP0409RS51 AN EG C Separation plate unit
63
\ 2nd (2nd paper transfer section)
3
3 2 1
2
1
4
a
a
b
7 8
6
b
8
9
26 5
23
25 31
19 28
24 29
27
22 15
17 14
21 18
24 20 35 33 13 16
34
503 12
27 34
30 11
PRP03732
64
] 2nd (2nd drive section)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 PCOVP0084QSZZ AE DJ C 2nd bottom cover 2nd
2 CPWBF0228QSE1 AX FG N E 2nd cassette interface PWB 2nd
3 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
5 NBRGC0100FCZ1 AC DJ C Bearing 6 6
6 MARMP0018QSZZ AD DJ C Body joint arm
8 XRESP40-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E4) E
9 XRESP50-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E5) E
10 MSPRT0203QSZZ AC DJ C Joint spring
11 NGERH0119QSZZ AD DJ C Gear(36T)
12 NGERH1207FCZZ AF DS C Joint gear(40T)
13 CDAIU0024RS58 AZ FQ E 2nd lift up unit 2nd
14 XEBS740P30000 AC DD C Screw(430)
15 XEBS740P12000 AA DD C Screw(412)
20 LPLTM0203QSZ1 AF DS C Multi step drive plate
24 NGERH0121QSZZ AE DJ C Gear(20T/45T/26P)
25 NBLTT0029QSZZ AG DX B Vertical transport belt
26 PCLC-0020QSZZ AX FG B Transport clutch
28 NPLYZ0027QSZZ AD DJ C Vertical transport pulley
29 PSHEZ0250QSZZ AB DJ C Flange sheet
30 NROLP0008QSZZ AD DJ C Pulley
31 PSHEZ0249QSZZ AB DJ C Flange sheet
32 NBRGC0529FCZZ AD DJ C Bearing
33 LPLTM0176QSZ1 AH EB C Clutch earth plate
34 PSHEZ0556QSZZ AC DJ C Harness holder sheet
2
1
3
11
3
29
25
30 b 13
a
32
9 24 a
33 31 14
10 28 8 15 14
12 26 34 15
20 15
15
5
b
6
9
8
PRP03733
65
^ (Lift up unit)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 CMOTV0778FCE3 AU EZ E Lift up motor unit
2 NGERH0158QSZ1 AE DJ C Gear(29T/11T)
3 LDAIU0024QSZ2 AF DS D Lift up base
4 NGERH0102QSZZ AD DJ C Gear(53T/14T)
5 NSFTZ0045QSZZ AC DJ C Shaft
6 NGERH0103QSZZ AE DJ C Gear(54T/13T)
7 NSFTZ0044QSZZ AC DJ C Shaft
8 NSFTZ0060QSZZ AC DJ C Shaft
9 NGERH0104QSZZ AE DJ C Gear(13T/42T)
10 NGERH0105QSZZ AD DJ C Gear(19T)
11 PCOVP0061QSZ2 AH DS D Lift up cover
MSPRD0208QSZZ AC DJ C 1st cassette earth spring 1st
12
MSPRD0251QSZZ AD DJ C 2nd cassette earth spring 2nd
13 MSPRC0263QSZZ AC DJ C Lift up spring
(Unit)
CDAIU0024RS57 AZ FQ E 1st lift up unit 1st
901
CDAIU0024RS58 AZ FQ E 2nd lift up unit 2nd
^ (Lift up unit)
1
13 12
12
2
5
7
8
4
6
9
11 10 PRP03734
66
_ (2nd delivery paper unit)[Option for EX]
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 XHBS740P10000 AA DD C Screw(410)
2 CPLTM0216QS01 AH DX C DID rail sub plate DID
3 PBRSR0021QSZ1 AG DS B Discharger brush S S
4 PBRSR0020QSZ1 AH DX B Discharger brush L L
5 LFRM-0047QSZZ AG DX D Delivery frame
6 LFRM-0058QSZ1 AG DX N D Delivery frame R R
7 MSPRT0229GCAZ AC DJ C FU spring R FU R
8 NROLP1122FCZZ AF DS C PS upper roller PS
9 NROLR0056QSZ1 AN EQ C Delivery roller
10 DHAI-0592QSPZ AH DX N C 2nd delivery harness 2nd
11 MSPRD0218QSZ1 AE DS N C Delivery earth spring
12 VHPGP1SQ44S-18 AK EB B Photo sensor(GP1SQ44S)
13 VHPGP1SQ73P-18 AF DS B Photo sensor(GP1SQ73P)
15 QSW-B0017QSZZ AF DS B Tray detect switch
16 NBRGM0501FCZZ AB DJ C Bearing
17 NGERH0111QSZZ AC DJ C Drive gear A(25T) A
18 NGERH0110QSZZ AE DJ C Idle gear A(29T) A
19 NGERH0112QSZZ AC DJ C Drive gear B(25T) B
20 NBRGY2122SCZZ AB DD C Transport roller bearing
21 PGIDM0164QSZZ AQ EQ N C Delivery lower paper guide
22 NROLR0051QSZ1 AL EB C DUP delivery roller DUP
23 LBSHZ0303FCZZ AC DJ C M bushing C M C
24 XRESP40-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E4) E
25 MLEVP0067QSZ2 AD DJ C Delivery actuator
26 XRESP50-06000 AA DD C E type ring(E5) E
27 XHBS730P08000 AB DD C Screw(38)
28 XHBS740P10000 AA DD C Screw(410)
29 NSFTZ0117QSZZ AE DS N C Joint idle shaft
30 PCLR-0015QSZZ AC DJ N C 21 collar 21
31 NGERH0230QSZZ AC DJ N C Gear(21T)
32 XBPS740P08KS0 AB DD C Screw(48KS)
2 32
10 11
29
30
1 4 8
31 18
7
26 8 17
3 7 16
5
8
7 9 19
8 12
20
15
7
27
13
21
25
28 22
26 16
23
24
PRP03735 27
67
. (Job-separater unit)[Option for EX]
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
2 GCOV-0042QST1 AK DX N D Rail dummy cover
3 MLEVP0066QSZZ AD DJ C Actuator
4 XEBS730P08000 AC DD C Screw(38)
4 PRP03736
68
a (Packing material & accessories)
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
TINSE2026QSZZ AY FQ N D Operation manual [English]
TINSE2027QSZZ AK DX N D Operation manual(Copy/SPLC install guide) [English]
2
CDSKA0261QS31 AH DX N D CD-ROM CD-ROM
CCADZ1518FC01 AB DJ D Maintenance card EX EX
8 LX-BZ0015QSPZ AF DS C 2/3 fixing screw 2/3
9 TCADZ0010QSZZ AC DJ D Fixing screw caution card
10 LHLDW1226FCZZ AB DJ C Turn fastener
11 TCADZ1275FCZZ AB DJ D Cassette rotation tag
12 SSAKA3001CCZZ AA DD D Vinyl bag(140360)
13 SSAKA2343QCZZ AA DD D Vinyl bag(260380)
14 SPAKA0134RSZZ AL EB D OC protect sheet OC
13
10
8 11
9
12
14
PRP03737
69
b (Job-separater Packing material & accessories)[Option for EX]
PRICE RANK NEW PART
NO. PARTS CODE Ex. Ja. MARK RANK DESCRIPTION
1 XEBS740P10000 AA DD C Screw(410)
2 XHBS740P10000 AA DD C Screw(410)
3 SSAKA0006UCZZ AA DD D Vinyl bag(5060)
4 LHLDZ0149QSZZ AH DX C 2nd delivery holder 2
7 SSAK-4271CCZZ AD DJ D Vinyl bag(420690)
9 SSAKA2540QCZZ AB DD D Vinyl bag(260560)
PRP03738
70
(Index) PRICE R.
PARTS CODE NO. Ex. Ja.
NEW P/R
PRICE R. CSOU-0037RS53 4- 501 CD UD N E
PARTS CODE NO. Ex. Ja.
NEW P/R
CSOU-0038RS53 3- 502 CE UH N E
[C] CSW-M0007RS56 13- 36 AP EQ B
CBDGD0062FC34 2- 68 AH DX N C CTME-0021RS51 21- 502 AK EB A
CBDGD0062FC35 2- 68 AH DX N C [D]
CBRC-0004QS03 26- 29 AF DS C DHAI-0200QSZZ 10- 9 AS EZ C
CBTN-0290FC01 8- 19 AK DX C " 27- 37 AS EZ C
CBTN-0291FC02 8- 23 AG DX C DHAI-0345QSZZ 12- 30 AG DX C
CBTN-0292FC03 8- 20 AR EQ N C " 27- 22 AG DX C
CCAB-0077RS53 5- 501 BP LP N E DHAI-0347QSPZ 12- 4 AN EQ C
CCADZ1518FC01 37- 2 AB DJ D " 27- 38 AN EQ C
CCASP0005RS59 30- 901 BK HC N E DHAI-0350QSPZ 15- 21 AG DX C
CCASP0006RS59 14- 901 BH GX N E " 27- 41 AG DX N C
CCLEZ0011QS32 21- 32 BD GN N A DHAI-0354QSPZ 13- 55 AG DS C
CCLEZ0020QS01 3- 37 AK EB C DHAI-0359QSZZ 18- 13 AP EQ C
CDAIU0012QS15 11- 2 BG GT C DHAI-0360QSPZ 19- 49 AE DJ C
" 12- 8 BG GT C DHAI-0367QSPZ 22- 10 AE DJ C
CDAIU0024RS57 28- 13 AZ FQ E DHAI-0370QSPZ 2- 73 AF DS C
" 34- 901 AZ FQ E DHAI-0378QSPZ 28- 8 AC DJ C
CDAIU0024RS58 33- 13 AZ FQ E DHAI-0381QSPZ 27- 43 AH DX C
" 34- 901 AZ FQ E DHAI-0388QSPZ 4- 13 AE DS C
CDOR-0002RS62 17- 901 BF GN N E DHAI-0390QSZZ 5- 22 AC DJ C
CDSKA0261QS31 37- 2 AH DX N D DHAI-0394QSPZ 31- 29 AD DJ C
CFIX-0013QS11 1- 3 AL EB N D DHAI-0397QSPZ 31- 17 AD DJ C
CFRM-0038RS74 25- 901 BP LP N E DHAI-0398QSPZ 16- 20 AE DS C
" 26- 901 BP LP N E DHAI-0399QSPZ 15- 31 AF DS C
CFRM-0043QS03 9- 4 AX FQ D DHAI-0448QSZZ 4- 3 AV FG C
CFRM-0044QS03 9- 23 BB FX C DHAI-0467QSZZ 6- 18 AP EQ C
CFRM-0048RS55 19- 901 BE GN N E " 7- 2 AP EQ C
CFRM-0049RS5N 21- 901 BG GT N E DHAI-0468QSZZ 3- 35 AH DX C
CGERH0204RS51 24- 24 AX FQ C DHAI-0469QSZZ 5- 44 AG DX C
CGIDM0116QS05 1- 7 AK DX N C DHAI-0473QSP1 31- 31 AG DX N C
CHAI-0356RS51 13- 7 AL EB C DHAI-0503QSPZ 8- 3 AE DS C
CHAI-0603RS51 13- 8 AN EQ N C DHAI-0506QSPZ 13- 10 AQ EQ C
CHLDZ0150RS52 17- 33 BE GN N A " 27- 39 AQ EQ C
CLNS-0003RS55 12- 28 BP LE E DHAI-0566QSPZ 20- 20 AQ EQ C
CMIR-0008QS36 11- 7 BB GD E DHAI-0592QSPZ 35- 10 AH DX N C
CMOTV0778FCE3 34- 1 AU EZ E DHAI-0595QSPZ 27- 72 AE DS N C
CPLTM0084QS02 11- 17 AK DX C DHAI-0602QSPZ 24- 25 AE DS N C
CPLTM0160QS02 24- 3 AU FG C DHAI-0609QSPZ 13- 93 AK DX N C
CPLTM0160RS59 13- 67 BH HC N E DHAI-0610QSP1 12- 48 BF GN N C
" 24- 901 BH HC N E " 27- 42 BF GN N C
CPLTM0160RS60 13- 67 BH HC N E DUNT-0777RSZZ 20- 901 BN HZ N E
" 24- 901 BH HC N E DUNTK0034QSP3 10- 8 BK HC N E
CPLTM0161QS02 24- 20 AP EQ C DUNTK0616RSZZ 13- 1 BV NU E
CPLTM0216QS01 35- 2 AH DX C DUNTW0782RSZZ 22- 901 BW RJ N E
CPLTM0336QS02 22- 31 AR EQ A " 23- 901 BW RJ N E
CPLTM0342QS01 9- 42 AH DX C [G]
CPLTM0345QS01 19- 27 AG DX C GCAB-0030QSTB 29- 1 AL EB N D
CPLTP0409RS51 16- 504 AN EG C GCAB-0042QSTF 2- 1 AP EQ N D
" 32- 503 AN EG C GCAB-0043QSTC 2- 6 AM EG N D
CPNLC0070QS02 8- 15 AR EQ N C GCAB-0074QST1 3- 9 AH DX N D
CPNLC0070RS51 8- 901 CC UB N E GCAB-0075QST1 3- 1 AR EQ N D
CPNLC0072QS05 8- 11 AX FG N C GCAB-0076QST1 5- 1 AN EG N D
CPNLH0073QS01 8- 32 AZ FQ N C GCAB-0077QST1 5- 24 AP EQ N D
CPNLH0073QS02 8- 32 AP EQ N C GCAB-0078QST1 3- 20 AV FG N D
CPNLH0073QS03 8- 32 AP EQ N C GCAB-0080QST1 1- 2 AM EG N D
CPNLH0073QS04 8- 32 AS EQ N C GCAB-0081QST1 1- 1 AL EB N D
CPWBF0081QSE2 15- 2 AP EQ E GCAB-0084QST1 1- 6 AS EQ N D
CPWBF0083QSE5 12- 7 AU EZ E GCAB-0085QST5 2- 8 AY FQ N D
" 19- 48 AU EZ E GCAB-0141QSZZ 2- 26 AT EZ N C
CPWBF0095QSE3 31- 4 AP EQ E GCAB-0142QSZZ 2- 23 AL EB N C
CPWBF0106QSE4 18- 17 AP EQ E GCAB-0143QSZZ 2- 74 BA FX N D
CPWBF0139QSE1 4- 1 BA FX E GCAB-0144QSZZ 2- 65 AK DX N C
CPWBF0160QSE1 3- 24 AS EQ E GCAB-0145QSZZ 2- 4 AU EZ N C
CPWBF0222QSE3 25- 18 AK EB N E GCAB-0148QSZZ 2- 24 AW FG N C
CPWBF0228QSE1 33- 2 AX FG N E GCASP0005QSZ4 30- 5 BA GD D
CPWBF0234QSE2 8- 25 AX FG N E GCASP0006QSZZ 14- 5 BA FX D
CPWBF0235QSE1 27- 4 BB GD N E GCOV-0034QSTC 2- 9 AK DX N C
CPWBN0137QSE1 27- 13 AZ FX E GCOV-0042QST1 36- 2 AK DX N D
CPWBX0136QS3L 27- 1 CB TX N E GCOV-0043QST2 2- 17 AX FG N D
CPWBX0136QS3M 27- 1 CB TX N E GCOV-0056QST1 2- 5 AG DS N D
CPWBX0202RS55 27- 29 BZ TR N E GCOV-0086QSZZ 2- 19 AN EG N C
CPWBX0211QSF2 8- 4 BR LX N E GCOV-0282FCZZ 14- 23 AH DX D
CPWBX0233QS31 27- 10 CD UD N E " 30- 25 AH DX D
CPWBX0233QS32 27- 10 CD UD N E GCOVA0025QSTC 29- 5 AR EQ N D
CSFTB0073QS01 5- 34 AF DS E GLEGG0064FCZZ 29- 15 AC DJ D
CSFTZ0023QS04 25- 21 AE DS N C [H]
CSHEZ0244QS02 30- 15 AE DJ C HBDGD0058FCZZ 2- 67 AT EQ C
CSOU-0024RS65 18- 901 BF GN N E HPNLH0264FCZZ 8- 10 BF GN B
CSOU-0037RS53 3- 501 CD UD N E
71
PRICE R. PRICE R.
PARTS CODE NO. Ex. Ja.
NEW P/R PARTS CODE NO. Ex. Ja.
NEW P/R
72
PRICE R. PRICE R.
PARTS CODE NO. Ex. Ja.
NEW P/R PARTS CODE NO. Ex. Ja.
NEW P/R
73
PRICE R. PRICE R.
PARTS CODE NO. Ex. Ja.
NEW P/R PARTS CODE NO. Ex. Ja.
NEW P/R
MSPRC0360QSZZ 6- 48 AC DJ C NBLTT0033QSZZ 5- 42 AF DS B
MSPRC0378QSZ1 32- 1 AB DJ C NBLTT0034QSZZ 7- 10 AF DS B
MSPRC0418QSZZ 7- 34 AC DJ N C NBLTT0035QSZZ 7- 18 AE DS B
MSPRC1315FCZ1 19- 15 AD DJ C NBLTT0036QSZZ 6- 38 AF DS B
" 9- 62 AD DJ C NBLTT0038QSZZ 9- 45 AF DS B
MSPRC1316FCZ1 19- 22 AE DS C NBRGC0017QSZZ 6- 39 AC DJ C
MSPRC1318FCZ1 13- 51 AA DJ C " 7- 23 AC DJ C
" 19- 33 AA DJ C NBRGC0018QSZZ 13- 31 AD DJ C
MSPRC2175FCZZ 19- 31 AA DJ C " 3- 13 AD DJ C
MSPRC2631FCZZ 14- 12 AC DJ C " 5- 17 AD DJ C
" 30- 12 AC DJ C NBRGC0019QSZZ 26- 18 AD DJ C
MSPRC3356FCZZ 6- 21 AA DJ C NBRGC0020QSZZ 20- 33 AH DX C
MSPRD0189QSZZ 2- 11 AB DJ C NBRGC0100FCZ1 15- 19 AC DJ C
MSPRD0190QSZ2 13- 11 AD DJ C " 31- 18 AC DJ C
MSPRD0191QSZ2 13- 12 AD DJ C " 33- 5 AC DJ C
MSPRD0192QSZ2 13- 13 AD DJ C NBRGC0529FCZZ 33- 32 AD DJ C
MSPRD0194QSZ1 16- 3 AD DJ C NBRGM0096FCZ1 5- 7 AC DJ C
MSPRD0196QSZZ 26- 26 AC DJ C NBRGM0501FCZZ 25- 10 AB DJ C
MSPRD0198QSZZ 26- 23 AC DJ C " 35- 16 AB DJ C
MSPRD0201QSZZ 15- 6 AC DJ C " 4- 28 AB DJ C
MSPRD0202QSZZ 16- 21 AB DJ C " 6- 22 AB DJ C
MSPRD0204QSZZ 31- 30 AC DJ C " 7- 12 AB DJ C
MSPRD0205QSZZ 17- 30 AE DS C NBRGP0011QSZZ 11- 33 AC DJ C
MSPRD0208QSZZ 34- 12 AC DJ C NBRGP0012QSZZ 11- 22 AC DJ C
MSPRD0211QSZZ 4- 14 AC DJ C NBRGP0023QSZZ 17- 52 AD DJ C
MSPRD0216QSZZ 26- 13 AD DJ C NBRGP0025QSZZ 22- 29 AN EQ A
MSPRD0218QSZ1 35- 11 AE DS N C NBRGP0041GCZZ 14- 21 AD DJ C
MSPRD0222QSZZ 17- 8 AC DJ C " 30- 21 AD DJ C
MSPRD0224QSZZ 25- 14 AB DJ C " 4- 41 AD DJ C
MSPRD0232QSZZ 12- 15 AB DJ C NBRGP0299FCPZ 21- 23 AD DJ C
MSPRD0233QSZ1 16- 10 AC DJ C NBRGY0022QSZZ 23- 1 AL EB A
MSPRD0251QSZZ 34- 12 AD DJ C NBRGY0769FCZ2 20- 22 AQ EB C
MSPRD0287QSZZ 16- 40 AC DJ C NBRGY2122SCZZ 25- 8 AB DD C
" 32- 27 AC DJ C " 26- 17 AB DD C
MSPRD0302QSZZ 19- 45 AC DJ C " 35- 20 AB DD C
MSPRD0305QSZZ 4- 24 AC DJ C NBRGZ0503FCZZ 32- 17 AC DJ C
MSPRD0309QSZZ 5- 5 AC DJ C NCPL-0003QSZ1 21- 7 AC DJ C
MSPRD0310QSZZ 5- 28 AC DJ C NCPL-0009QSZZ 24- 22 AC DJ C
MSPRD0313QSZZ 5- 50 AC DJ C NCPL-0011QSZZ 13- 49 AC DJ C
MSPRD0314QSZZ 5- 14 AD DJ C NCPL-0012QSZZ 19- 47 AD DJ C
MSPRD0316QSZZ 6- 40 AC DJ C NCPL-0049FCBZ 5- 37 AT EZ C
MSPRD0322QSZZ 22- 33 AC DJ C NFANP0020QSPZ 25- 42 AP EQ N B
MSPRD0326QSZZ 23- 17 AC DJ C " 28- 38 AP EQ N B
MSPRD0327QSZ1 23- 15 AC DJ C " 9- 68 AP EQ N B
MSPRD0328QSZ1 23- 11 AC DJ C NFANP0081FCZZ 13- 80 BA FX B
MSPRD0329QSZZ 19- 46 AC DJ C NGERH0010QSZZ 24- 12 AD DJ C
MSPRD0340QSZZ 16- 47 AC DJ C NGERH0027QSZZ 11- 30 AH DX C
MSPRD0342QSZZ 4- 9 AD DJ C NGERH0036QSZZ 21- 16 AC DJ C
MSPRD0347QSZZ 19- 20 AD DJ C NGERH0037QSZZ 21- 20 AC DJ C
MSPRD0389QSZZ 15- 18 AC DJ C NGERH0038QSZZ 21- 21 AC DJ C
" 31- 19 AC DJ C NGERH0039QSZZ 21- 18 AE DS C
MSPRD0395QSZZ 20- 37 AC DJ C NGERH0061QSZZ 19- 7 AD DJ C
MSPRP0123QSZZ 4- 35 AD DJ C NGERH0066QSZZ 9- 63 AD DJ C
MSPRP0145QSZZ 10- 6 AF DS C NGERH0074QSZZ 17- 5 AD DJ C
MSPRP0306QSZZ 4- 31 AC DJ C NGERH0080QSZZ 26- 21 AE DJ C
MSPRP0311QSZZ 5- 26 AC DJ C NGERH0082QSZZ 26- 22 AD DJ C
MSPRP0312QSZZ 7- 21 AD DJ C NGERH0084QSZZ 24- 7 AK DX C
MSPRP0315QSZZ 3- 30 AD DJ C NGERH0086QSZZ 24- 10 AD DJ C
MSPRP0345QSZ1 32- 8 AD DJ C NGERH0087QSZZ 24- 11 AE DJ C
MSPRP2830FCZZ 18- 14 AA DJ C NGERH0090QSZ1 24- 6 AF DS C
MSPRP3009FCZZ 8- 5 AD DJ C NGERH0091QSZZ 24- 23 AE DJ C
MSPRT0147QSZZ 9- 71 AC DJ C NGERH0092QSZZ 24- 13 AD DJ C
MSPRT0197QSZ1 25- 16 AC DJ N C NGERH0093QSZZ 24- 14 AD DJ C
MSPRT0203QSZZ 33- 10 AC DJ C NGERH0095QSZZ 24- 16 AE DJ C
MSPRT0214QSZZ 21- 28 AB DJ C NGERH0096QSZZ 24- 19 AE DJ C
MSPRT0217QSZ1 26- 14 AC DJ C NGERH0097QSZZ 15- 20 AF DS C
MSPRT0221QSZZ 13- 39 AB DJ C NGERH0102QSZZ 34- 4 AD DJ C
MSPRT0229GCAZ 2- 15 AC DJ C NGERH0103QSZZ 34- 6 AE DJ C
" 25- 28 AC DJ C NGERH0104QSZZ 34- 9 AE DJ C
" 35- 7 AC DJ C NGERH0105QSZZ 34- 10 AD DJ C
MSPRT0257QSZ1 22- 32 AC DJ C NGERH0107QSZZ 15- 17 AD DJ C
MSPRT0279QSZ1 17- 14 AC DJ C " 31- 21 AD DJ C
MSPRT0308QSZZ 4- 36 AC DJ C NGERH0108QSZZ 14- 17 AD DJ C
MSPRT0317QSZZ 7- 27 AC DJ C " 30- 17 AD DJ C
MSPRT0351QSZZ 19- 9 AC DJ C NGERH0110QSZZ 35- 18 AE DJ C
[N] NGERH0111QSZZ 35- 17 AC DJ C
NBLTH0494FCZZ 20- 27 AD DJ B NGERH0112QSZZ 35- 19 AC DJ C
NBLTT0002QSZZ 11- 29 AH DX B NGERH0113QSZZ 26- 24 AC DJ C
NBLTT0024QSZZ 26- 20 AG DS B NGERH0114QSZZ 26- 25 AC DJ C
NBLTT0026QSZZ 9- 19 AF DS B NGERH0116QSZ1 7- 13 AD DJ C
NBLTT0029QSZZ 33- 25 AG DX B NGERH0117QSZZ 7- 15 AK DX C
74
PRICE R. PRICE R.
PARTS CODE NO. Ex. Ja.
NEW P/R PARTS CODE NO. Ex. Ja.
NEW P/R
75
PRICE R. PRICE R.
PARTS CODE NO. Ex. Ja.
NEW P/R PARTS CODE NO. Ex. Ja.
NEW P/R
PCUSS0011QSZZ 1- 22 AB DJ C PSHEZ0207QSZZ 1- 20 AC DJ C
PCUSS0022QSZ3 3- 15 AW EQ C PSHEZ0208QSZZ 1- 23 AC DJ C
PCUSS0027QSZZ 1- 24 AA DJ C PSHEZ0217QSZZ 12- 21 AC DJ C
PCUSS0033QSZZ 10- 11 AC DJ C PSHEZ0218QSZZ 12- 20 AC DJ C
PCUSU0203FCZZ 10- 5 AE DS C PSHEZ0219QSZZ 12- 32 AC DJ C
PDUC-0010QSZZ 13- 92 AH DX N D PSHEZ0220QSZ1 1- 4 AK DX C
PFILD0313FCZZ 20- 2 AG DX A PSHEZ0221QSZZ 1- 18 AC DJ C
PFILW0319FCZZ 8- 21 AK EB C PSHEZ0222QSZZ 1- 21 AC DJ C
PFILZ0016QSZZ 2- 18 AS EQ B PSHEZ0241QSZZ 19- 42 AB DJ C
PFILZ0017QSZ1 25- 39 AP EQ A PSHEZ0242QSZ1 16- 17 AH DX C
PFTA-0019QSZZ 16- 15 AE DS D PSHEZ0244QSZ2 14- 15 AC DJ C
PGIDH0093QSZ3 17- 46 AN EG C PSHEZ0249QSZZ 33- 31 AB DJ C
PGIDH0140QSZZ 23- 8 AY FQ A PSHEZ0250QSZZ 33- 29 AB DJ C
PGIDM0067QST1 16- 9 AP EQ N C PSHEZ0254QSZZ 12- 34 AC DJ C
PGIDM0068QSZ1 32- 4 AP EG C PSHEZ0269QSZZ 27- 20 AC DJ C
PGIDM0070QSZ1 14- 6 AM EG D PSHEZ0273QSZZ 12- 38 AB DJ C
" 30- 6 AM EG C PSHEZ0274QSZZ 14- 4 AC DJ C
PGIDM0071QSZZ 14- 9 AL EB D " 30- 4 AC DJ C
" 30- 9 AL EB C PSHEZ0285QSZZ 4- 20 AB DJ C
PGIDM0074QSZZ 32- 23 AK DX C PSHEZ0301QSZZ 16- 33 AC DJ C
PGIDM0105QSZ1 5- 23 AQ EQ C " 32- 25 AC DJ C
PGIDM0106QSZ1 6- 45 AU EZ C PSHEZ0302QSZZ 16- 34 AC DJ C
PGIDM0107QSZ1 6- 1 AQ EQ C " 32- 26 AC DJ C
PGIDM0108QST1 11- 35 AG DX N C PSHEZ0307QSZ1 17- 34 AB DJ C
PGIDM0109QST1 11- 37 AG DX N C PSHEZ0314QSZ2 16- 43 AF DS C
PGIDM0113QSZZ 22- 35 AT EZ C PSHEZ0316QSZZ 26- 35 AD DJ C
PGIDM0115QSZZ 23- 18 AS EQ C PSHEZ0325QSZZ 29- 22 AB DJ C
PGIDM0158QSZZ 20- 4 AH DX N C " 9- 41 AB DJ C
PGIDM0159QSZZ 20- 7 AM EG N C PSHEZ0329QSZZ 21- 34 AC DJ C
PGIDM0164QSZZ 35- 21 AQ EQ N C PSHEZ0333QSZZ 9- 40 AC DJ C
PGIDM0165QSZ1 25- 26 AR EQ N C PSHEZ0347QSZ1 32- 31 AC DJ C
PGIDM0184QSZ1 28- 11 AH DX N C PSHEZ0356QSZ1 32- 30 AE DS C
PGIDM0186QSZZ 16- 53 AK DX N D PSHEZ0391QSZ1 15- 36 AC DJ N C
PGLSP0003QSZZ 1- 11 BA FX B PSHEZ0392QSZ1 15- 37 AB DJ N C
PGLSP0004QSZZ 1- 19 AX FG B " 2- 75 AB DJ N C
PGSK-0008QSPZ 12- 39 AF DS C PSHEZ0393QSZ1 15- 38 AA DJ N C
PGSK-0044QSPZ 9- 56 AH DX C PSHEZ0394QSZ1 13- 65 AB DJ N C
PGUMS0002QSPZ 11- 18 AL EB C PSHEZ0407QSZZ 5- 51 AB DJ C
PGUMS0004QSZZ 11- 20 AA DJ C PSHEZ0413QSZZ 3- 16 AD DJ C
" 12- 9 AA DJ C PSHEZ0414QSZZ 7- 9 AB DJ C
PLNS-0105FCZZ 8- 22 AC DJ B PSHEZ0420QSZZ 12- 43 AC DJ C
PMIR-0009QSZZ 10- 7 AS EQ B PSHEZ0423QSZZ 6- 4 AP EQ C
PMLT-0002YSZ1 20- 41 AC DJ C PSHEZ0426QSZZ 12- 45 AB DJ C
PMLT-0018QSZ1 21- 24 AC DJ C PSHEZ0431QSZ1 17- 36 AF DS C
PMLT-0044QSZZ 17- 58 AA DJ C PSHEZ0432QSZZ 9- 64 AA DJ C
PMLT-0091QSZ1 9- 55 AD DJ C PSHEZ0436QSZZ 4- 37 AD DJ C
PMLT-0093QSZZ 1- 26 AB DJ C PSHEZ0439QSZ1 4- 39 AD DJ C
PMLT-0094QSZZ 12- 41 AC DJ C PSHEZ0444QSZZ 5- 45 AE DS C
PMLT-0095QSZZ 5- 54 AB DJ C PSHEZ0448QSZZ 12- 22 AA DJ C
PMLT-0116QSZZ 13- 75 AE DJ C " 9- 67 AA DJ C
PMLT-0117QSZZ 13- 76 AD DJ C PSHEZ0451QSZZ 6- 7 AC DJ C
PMLT-0118QSZ1 13- 88 AC DJ C PSHEZ0452QSZZ 6- 2 AF DS C
PMLT-0120QSZ1 13- 74 AL EB C PSHEZ0454QSZZ 6- 46 AB DJ C
PMLT-0141QSZZ 20- 11 AC DJ C PSHEZ0455QSZZ 6- 47 AD DJ C
PMLT-0142QSZZ 20- 9 AC DJ C PSHEZ0459QSZZ 4- 44 AC DJ C
PMLT-0146QSZZ 20- 16 AB DJ N C PSHEZ0463QSZZ 16- 36 AD DJ C
PMLT-0147QSZZ 20- 12 AB DJ N C PSHEZ0474QSZZ 1- 27 AD DJ C
PMLT-0148QSZZ 13- 89 AB DJ N C PSHEZ0507QSZZ 9- 7 AA DJ C
PPIPP0014QSZZ 19- 23 AC DJ C PSHEZ0515QSZZ 16- 23 AG DX A
PPIPP0017QSZZ 21- 13 AE DS N C " 32- 14 AG DX A
PPIPP0109FCZ1 19- 16 AC DJ C PSHEZ0556QSZZ 33- 34 AC DJ C
PRDAZ0002QSZZ 26- 36 AD DJ C PSHEZ0557QSZZ 21- 44 AC DJ C
PREFL0004QSZZ 10- 1 AP EQ B PSHEZ0568QSZZ 2- 61 AD DJ C
PRNGF0106FCZ2 21- 38 AC DJ A PSHEZ0646QSPZ 8- 1 AE DJ N C
PRNGF0107FCZ1 17- 61 AC DJ C PSHEZ0650QSZZ 25- 36 AB DJ N C
PRNGP0081FCZ1 21- 39 AB DJ C PSHEZ0651QSZZ 20- 30 AA DJ N A
PRNGP0090FCZ1 4- 42 AB DJ C PSHEZ0652QSZZ 20- 28 AA DJ N A
PSEL-0070QSZZ 21- 11 AF DS A PSHEZ0655QSZZ 25- 38 AD DJ N C
PSEL-0071QSZZ 21- 10 AF DS A PSHEZ5764FCZZ 8- 9 AC DJ C
PSEL-0162QSZZ 20- 5 AE DJ A PSHEZ5948FCZZ 14- 25 AD DJ C
PSEL-0163QSZ1 17- 59 AH DX N C " 30- 26 AD DJ C
PSEL-0964FCZ1 20- 10 AA DJ C PSHT-0014QSZZ 21- 12 AC DJ C
PSHEP0632QSZZ 20- 42 AB DJ C PSPAB0039QSZZ 27- 3 AG DJ C
PSHEP0647QSZZ 6- 15 AD DJ N C PSPAN0025QSZZ 27- 86 AE DS C
PSHEP3029FCZZ 6- 26 AA DD C PSPAZ0041QSZZ 13- 70 AA DJ C
" 7- 19 AA DD C PSPAZ0055QSZZ 32- 34 AA DJ C
PSHEZ0069QSZZ 4- 38 AE DJ C PSPAZ0696FCZZ 21- 15 AC DJ C
PSHEZ0077QSZ1 3- 17 AE DJ C PSPO-0003QSZZ 4- 22 AC DJ C
PSHEZ0099QSZZ 19- 3 AC DJ C PSPO-0004QSZZ 4- 7 AB DJ C
PSHEZ0108QSZZ 12- 31 AC DJ C PSPO-0020QSZZ 4- 19 AB DJ C
PSHEZ0133QSZZ 16- 7 AD DJ C PSPO-0022QSZZ 7- 7 AB DJ C
76
PRICE R. PRICE R.
PARTS CODE NO. Ex. Ja.
NEW P/R PARTS CODE NO. Ex. Ja.
NEW P/R
77
PRICE R. PRICE R.
PARTS CODE NO. Ex. Ja.
NEW P/R PARTS CODE NO. Ex. Ja.
NEW P/R
78
q
COPYRIGHT 2009 BY SHARP CORPORATION
All rights reserved.
Printed in Japan.
No part of this publication may be reproduced,
stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted.
In any form or by any means,
electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or otherwise,
without prior written permission of the publisher.
SHARP CORPORATION
Business Solutions Group
CS PROMOTION CENTER
Yamatokoriyama, Nara 639-1186, Japan
2009 August Printed in Japan t